blob: 60857739e546b59dd3305343b03354aee823c358 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau27010f02018-09-29 20:17:33 +02007 2018/09/29
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011210.1. Limitation
11310.2. Setup
11410.2.1. Cache section
11510.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116
1171. Quick reminder about HTTP
118----------------------------
119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
122on almost anything found in the contents.
123
124However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
125formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
126correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
127
128
1291.1. The HTTP transaction model
130-------------------------------
131
132The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100133to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
135connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136will involve a new connection :
137
138 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
139
140In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
141establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
142by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
143length.
144
145Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
146to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
147however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
148response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
149header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
154power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
155but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200156a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100158Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
160second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
161page :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
166latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
167correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
168the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100169server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
172time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
173are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
174parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
175carry the stream identifier.
176
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100177By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
178connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
179leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
181processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
182waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200183
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200184HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100185 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
186 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
187 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100188 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200189 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100191For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
192the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
194is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
195servers.
196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197
1981.2. HTTP request
199-----------------
200
201First, let's consider this HTTP request :
202
203 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100204 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
206 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
207 3 User-agent: my small browser
208 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
209 5 Accept: image/png
210
211
2121.2.1. The Request line
213-----------------------
214
215Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
216
217 - a METHOD : GET
218 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
219 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
220
221All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
222which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
223followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
224is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
225desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
226the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
227
228The URI itself can have several forms :
229
230 - A "relative URI" :
231
232 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233
234 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
235 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
236
237 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
238
239 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
240
241 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
242 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
243 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
244 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
245 must accept this form too.
246
247 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
248 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
249 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200251 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
252 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
253 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
254 other protocols too.
255
256In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
257mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
258on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
259It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
260specific to the language, framework or application in use.
261
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100262HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100263assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
265received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
266processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
267as well as in server logs.
268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200269
2701.2.2. The request headers
271--------------------------
272
273The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
274beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
275an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
276Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
277values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
278encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
279the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
280define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
281
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100282Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
285as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286
287The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
288that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
289is one valid form of empty line.
290
291Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
292headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
293about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
294application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
295
296Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000297 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
299 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
300 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
301
302
3031.3. HTTP response
304------------------
305
306An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
307messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
308
309 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100310 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
312 2 Content-length: 350
313 3 Content-Type: text/html
314
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
316codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
317response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100318continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
319the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
320following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
321sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
322(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
323correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
324such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
325state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
326over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
327if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
328information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200330
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003311.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332------------------------
333
334Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
335
336 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
337 - a status code : 200
338 - a reason : OK
339
340The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
342 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
343 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
344 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
345 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000347Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100348"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200349found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
350messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
351or "Authentication Required".
352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
355 Code When / reason
356 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
357 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
358 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100360 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362 400 for an invalid or too large request
363 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
364 accessing the stats page)
365 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
366 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
367 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
368 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
369 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
370 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
371 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
372 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
373 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
374
375The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3764.2).
377
378
3791.3.2. The response headers
380---------------------------
381
382Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
383the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
384details.
385
386
3872. Configuring HAProxy
388----------------------
389
3902.1. Configuration file format
391------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200392
393HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
394
395 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
396 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
397 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
398 "frontend" and "backend".
399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100400The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
401referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200402delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200404
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004052.2. Quoting and escaping
406-------------------------
407
408HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
409many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
410with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
411single quotes.
412
413If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
414them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
415escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
416
417Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
418
419 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
420 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
421 \\ to use a backslash
422 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
423 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
424
425Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
426the interpretation of:
427
428 space as a parameter separator
429 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
430 # hash as a comment start
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
433-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
434backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
435
436Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200437quoting.
438
439Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
440nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
441
442Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
443equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
444
445 Example:
446 # those are equivalents:
447 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
448 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
449 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
452
453 # those are equivalents:
454 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
458
459
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004602.3. Environment variables
461--------------------------
462
463HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
464interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
465configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
466optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
467shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
468underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
469
470 Example:
471
472 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
473
474 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
475
476 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
477
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200478A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
479which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
480
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200481
4822.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200483----------------
484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100485Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100486values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
487otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
488numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
489for every keyword. Supported units are :
490
491 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
492 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
493 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
494 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
495 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
496 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
497
498
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004992.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200500-------------
501
502 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
503 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
504 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
505 global
506 daemon
507 maxconn 256
508
509 defaults
510 mode http
511 timeout connect 5000ms
512 timeout client 50000ms
513 timeout server 50000ms
514
515 frontend http-in
516 bind *:80
517 default_backend servers
518
519 backend servers
520 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
521
522
523 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
524 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
525 global
526 daemon
527 maxconn 256
528
529 defaults
530 mode http
531 timeout connect 5000ms
532 timeout client 50000ms
533 timeout server 50000ms
534
535 listen http-in
536 bind *:80
537 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
538
539
540Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
541
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100542 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200543
544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005453. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546--------------------
547
548Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
549are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
550of them have command-line equivalents.
551
552The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
553
554 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200555 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200557 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200558 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200560 - description
561 - deviceatlas-json-file
562 - deviceatlas-log-level
563 - deviceatlas-separator
564 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900565 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566 - gid
567 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100568 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200570 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100571 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200572 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200574 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100577 - presetenv
578 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579 - uid
580 - ulimit-n
581 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100582 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200583 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-options
587 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200588 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-options
590 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100591 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100592 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100593 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100594 - 51degrees-data-file
595 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200596 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200597 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100598 - wurfl-data-file
599 - wurfl-information-list
600 - wurfl-information-list-separator
601 - wurfl-engine-mode
602 - wurfl-cache-size
603 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200606 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200608 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100609 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100610 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200612 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200613 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200614 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - noepoll
617 - nokqueue
618 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300620 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000621 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200622 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200623 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200624 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000625 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000626 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - tune.buffers.limit
628 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200629 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200630 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100631 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200632 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200633 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200634 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100635 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200636 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200637 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100638 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100639 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100640 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.session-timeout
642 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200643 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100644 - tune.maxaccept
645 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200646 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200647 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200648 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100649 - tune.rcvbuf.client
650 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100651 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200652 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100653 - tune.sndbuf.client
654 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100655 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100656 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200657 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200659 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200660 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100661 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200662 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100663 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
665 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
666 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100667 - tune.zlib.memlevel
668 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670 * Debugging
671 - debug
672 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673
674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006753.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676------------------------------------
677
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200678ca-base <dir>
679 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200680 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
681 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200682
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200683chroot <jail dir>
684 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
685 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
686 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
687 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
688 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100689 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100691cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
692 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
693 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
694 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
695 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
696 set. These sets have the format
697
698 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
699
700 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100701 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100702 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
703 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100704 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
705 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100706 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100707 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100708 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100709 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
711 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
712 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
713 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100714
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100715 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
716 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
717 on the machine's word size.
718
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100719 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100720 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
721 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
722 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
723 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
724 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
725 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100726
727 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100728 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
729
730 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
731 # first 4 CPUs
732
733 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
734 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
735 # word size.
736
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100737 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100738 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
742
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100743 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
744 # and so on.
745 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
748
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100750 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
751 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
752 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
753
754 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
755 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
756 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
757
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
759 # and a thread range.
760 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
761 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
763
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200764crt-base <dir>
765 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
766 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
767 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
768
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200769daemon
770 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
771 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100772 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
773 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200774
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200775deviceatlas-json-file <path>
776 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100777 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200778
779deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100780 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200781 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
782
783deviceatlas-separator <char>
784 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
785 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
786
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100787deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200788 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
789 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
790 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100791
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900792external-check
793 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
794 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
795 See "option external-check".
796
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200797gid <number>
798 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
799 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
800 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100801 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
802 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100804
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100805hard-stop-after <time>
806 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
807
808 Arguments :
809 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
810 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
811 SIGUSR1 signal.
812
813 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
814 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
815 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
816
817 Example:
818 global
819 hard-stop-after 30s
820
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200821group <group name>
822 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
823 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100824
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200825log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100826 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100828 configured with "log global".
829
830 <address> can be one of:
831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100832 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100833 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
834 port).
835
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100836 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
837 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
838 port).
839
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100840 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
841 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
842 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100843 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100844
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200845 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
846 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100847
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200848 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
849 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
850 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
851 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
852 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
853 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
854 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
855 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
856 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
857 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100858 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
859 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200860
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200861 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
862 one of the following :
863
864 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
865 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
866
867 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
868 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
869
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100870 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
872 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
873 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
874 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
875
876 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200877 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
878 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
879 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
880 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
881 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
882 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200884 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200885
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100886log-send-hostname [<string>]
887 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
888 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
889 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
890 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
891 the logs.
892
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000893log-tag <string>
894 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
895 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
896 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100897 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000898
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100899lua-load <file>
900 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
901 used multiple times.
902
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100903master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200904 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
905 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
906 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100907 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200908 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
909 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100910 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
911 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
912 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
913 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
914 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200915
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100916 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918nbproc <number>
919 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
920 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
921 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
922 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
923 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
924
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200925nbthread <number>
926 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
927 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
928 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
929 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
930 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100933 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200934 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
935 starting the process. See also "daemon".
936
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100937presetenv <name> <value>
938 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
939 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
940 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
941 and "unsetenv".
942
943resetenv [<name> ...]
944 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
945 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
946 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
947 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
948 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
949 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
950 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
951 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
952
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100953stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200954 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
955 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
956 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
957 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
958 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
959 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100960 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100961 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
962 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
963 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
964 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200965
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200966server-state-base <directory>
967 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200968 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
969 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200970
971server-state-file <file>
972 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
973 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
974 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
975 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
976 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
977 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
978 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
979 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200980 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
981 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200982
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100983setenv <name> <value>
984 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
985 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
986 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
987 and "unsetenv".
988
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100989ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
991 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200992 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
993 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
994 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
995 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
996 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
997 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
998
999ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1001 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1002 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1003 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1004 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1005 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1006 be for instance a string such as
1007 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1008 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1009 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1010 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001011
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001012ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1014 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1015 keyword to see available options.
1016
1017 Example:
1018 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001019 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001020
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001021ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1023 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001024 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1025 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1026 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1027 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1028 "server" keyword for more information.
1029
1030ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1032 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1033 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1034 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1035 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1036 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1037 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1038 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001039
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001040ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1042 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1043 keyword to see available options.
1044
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001045ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1047 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1048 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001049 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001050 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001051 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1052 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1053 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1054 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001055 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1056 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1057 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1058
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001059ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1060 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1061 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1062 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1063
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001064stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1065 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1066 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1067 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001068 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001069 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001070
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001071 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1072 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1073 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001074
1075stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1076 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1077 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001078 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001079
1080stats maxconn <connections>
1081 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1082 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1083
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084uid <number>
1085 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1086 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1087 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1088 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1089
1090ulimit-n <number>
1091 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1092 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1093 option.
1094
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001095unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1096 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1097
1098 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1099 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1100 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1101 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1102 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1103 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1104 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1105 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1106 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1107 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1108
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001109unsetenv [<name> ...]
1110 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1111 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1112 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1113 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1114 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1115 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1116 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1117
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118user <user name>
1119 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1120 See also "uid" and "group".
1121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001122node <name>
1123 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1124
1125 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1126 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1127 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1128 traffic.
1129
1130description <text>
1131 Add a text that describes the instance.
1132
1133 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1134 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1135 "<" and ">" characters.
1136
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100113751degrees-data-file <file path>
1138 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001139 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001140
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001141 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001142 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1143
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000114451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001145 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1146 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1147 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1148
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001149 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001150 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1151
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200115251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001153 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1154 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1155
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001156 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1157 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1158
115951degrees-cache-size <number>
1160 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1161 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1162 By default, this cache is disabled.
1163
1164 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001165 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1166
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001167wurfl-data-file <file path>
1168 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1169 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1170
1171 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1172 with USE_WURFL=1.
1173
1174wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1175 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1176 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1177 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1178
1179 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1180
1181 Valid WURFL properties are:
1182 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1183
1184 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1185 device.
1186
1187 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1188 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1189
1190 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1191 particular web request.
1192
1193 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1194 used Libwurfl API version.
1195
1196 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1197 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1198 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1199
1200 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1201 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1202
1203 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1204 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1205
1206 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1207
1208 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1209
1210 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1211 with USE_WURFL=1.
1212
1213wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1214 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1215 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1216
1217 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1218 with USE_WURFL=1.
1219
1220wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1221 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1222 thus before the chroot.
1223
1224 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1225 with USE_WURFL=1.
1226
1227wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1228 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1229 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001230 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001231 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001232 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001233 mode is enabled by default.
1234
1235 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1236 with USE_WURFL=1.
1237
1238wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1239 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1240 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1241 - "0" : no cache is used.
1242 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1243 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1244 the highest performing option.
1245
1246 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1247 with USE_WURFL=1.
1248
1249wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1250 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1251 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1252
1253 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1254 with USE_WURFL=1.
1255
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001258-----------------------
1259
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001260max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1261 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1262 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1263 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1264 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1265 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1266 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1267 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1268 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1269
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270maxconn <number>
1271 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1272 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1273 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001274 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1275 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1276 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1277 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001278 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1279 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1280 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1281 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1282 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001283
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001284maxconnrate <number>
1285 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1286 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1287 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1288 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1289 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1290 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1291 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1292 fairness.
1293
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001294maxcomprate <number>
1295 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001296 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001297 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1298 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1299 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001301 default value.
1302
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001303maxcompcpuusage <number>
1304 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1305 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1306 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1307 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1308 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1309 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1310 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1311 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1312
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001313maxpipes <number>
1314 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1315 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1316 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1317 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1318 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1319 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1320
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001321maxsessrate <number>
1322 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1323 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1324 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1325 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1326 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1327 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1328 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1329 fairness.
1330
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001331maxsslconn <number>
1332 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1333 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1334 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1335 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1336 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1337 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1338 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001339 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1340 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1341 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1342 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1343 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1344 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1345 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001346
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001347maxsslrate <number>
1348 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1349 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1350 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1351 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1352 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1353 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1354 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1355 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1356 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1357 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1358
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001359maxzlibmem <number>
1360 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1361 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1362 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001363 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1364 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1365 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1366
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001367noepoll
1368 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1369 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001370 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001371
1372nokqueue
1373 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1374 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1375 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1376
1377nopoll
1378 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1379 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001380 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001381 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001382
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001383nosplice
1384 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001385 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001386 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001387 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001388 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1389 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1390 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1391 "option splice-response".
1392
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001393nogetaddrinfo
1394 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1395 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1396
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001397noreuseport
1398 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1399 command line argument "-dR".
1400
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001401spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001402 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1403 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1404 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1405 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1406 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1407 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001408
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001409ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001410 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001411 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001412 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1413 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1414 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1415 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1416 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001417 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1418 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001419 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1420 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1421 openssl configuration file uses:
1422 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1423
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001424ssl-mode-async
1425 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001426 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001427 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1428 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1429 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1430 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1431 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001432
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001433tune.buffers.limit <number>
1434 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1435 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1436 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1437 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1438 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001439 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001440 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1441 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1442 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1443 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1444 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1445 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1446 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1447 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1448 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1449
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001450tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1451 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1452 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1453 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1454 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1455
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001456tune.bufsize <number>
1457 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1458 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1459 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1460 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1461 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1462 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1463 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001464 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1465 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1466 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001467 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1468 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001469
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001470tune.chksize <number>
1471 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1472 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1473 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1474 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1475 checks whenever possible.
1476
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001477tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1478 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1479 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1480 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1481 this value. The default value is 1.
1482
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001483tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1484 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1485 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1486 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1487 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1488 change it.
1489
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001490tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1491 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001492 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1493 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001494 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1495 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1496 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1497 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1498 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1499
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001500tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1501 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1502 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1503 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1504 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1505 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1506 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1507 recommended not to change this value.
1508
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001509tune.http.cookielen <number>
1510 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1511 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1512 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1513 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1514 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1515 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1516 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1517 to change this value.
1518
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001519tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001520 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1521 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001522 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001523 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001524 configuration directives too.
1525 The default value is 1024.
1526
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001527tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1528 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1529 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1530 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1531 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1532 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1533 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001534 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1535 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1536 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001537
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001538tune.idletimer <timeout>
1539 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1540 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1541 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1542 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1543 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1544 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001545 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001546 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1547 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1548
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001549tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1550 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001551 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001552 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1553 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001554 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001555 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1556 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1557
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001558tune.lua.maxmem
1559 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1560 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1561 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1562 memory.
1563
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001564tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1565 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001566 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1567 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001568 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001569
1570tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1571 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1572 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1573 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1574 check servers.
1575
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001576tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1577 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1578 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1579 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001580 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001581
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001582tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001583 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1584 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1585 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1586 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1587 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1588 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1589 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1590 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1591 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1592 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001593
1594tune.maxpollevents <number>
1595 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1596 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1597 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1598 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1599 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1600
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001601tune.maxrewrite <number>
1602 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1603 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1604 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1605 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1606 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1607 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1608 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1609 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1610 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1611 bufsize.
1612
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001613tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1614 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1615 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1616 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1617 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1618 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1619 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1620 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1621 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1622 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1623 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1624 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1625 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1626 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1627 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1628 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1629 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1630 setting this parameter to 0.
1631
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001632tune.pipesize <number>
1633 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1634 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1635 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1636 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1637 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1638 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1639
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001640tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1641tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1642 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1643 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1644 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1645 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001646 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001647 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1648 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1649
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001650tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001651 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001652 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1653 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1654 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1655 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1656
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001657tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1658 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1659 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1660 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1661
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001662tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1663tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1664 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1665 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1666 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1667 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001669 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1670 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1671 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1672 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1673 notifying haproxy again.
1674
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001675tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001676 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1677 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1678 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001679 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001680 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001681 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001682 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1683 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1684 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001685 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1686 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001687
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001688tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001689 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001690 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1691 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1692 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1693 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1694 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1695
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001696tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1697 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001698 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001699 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1700 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1701 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1702 being used for too long.
1703
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001704tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1705 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1706 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1707 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1708 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1709 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1710 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1711 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1712 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1713 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1714 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001716 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001717
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001718tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1719 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1720 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1721 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1722 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1723 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1724 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1725 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001726 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1727 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001728
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001729tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1730 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1731 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1732 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1733 1000 entries.
1734
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001735tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1736 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1737 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1738 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1739
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001740tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001741tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001742tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1743tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1744tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001745 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1746 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1747 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1748 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1749 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1750 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1751 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1752 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001753
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001754 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1755 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1756 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1757 all available space is consumed.
1758 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1759 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1760 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001761
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001762tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1763 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001764 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001765 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001766 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001767 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1768
1769tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1770 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1771 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001772 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1773 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017753.3. Debugging
1776--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001777
1778debug
1779 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1780 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1781 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1782 system startup.
1783
1784quiet
1785 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1786 line argument "-q".
1787
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017893.4. Userlists
1790--------------
1791It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1792http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1793it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1794
1795userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001796 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001797 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1798
1799group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001800 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001801 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1802 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1803
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001804user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1805 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001806 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1807 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001808 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1809 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1810 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1811 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001812
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001813 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1814 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1815 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1816 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1817 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1818 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1819 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1820 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1821 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001822
1823 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001824 userlist L1
1825 group G1 users tiger,scott
1826 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001827
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001828 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1829 user scott insecure-password elgato
1830 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001831
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001832 userlist L2
1833 group G1
1834 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001835
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001836 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1837 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1838 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001839
1840 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001841
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001842
18433.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001844----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001845It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1846several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1847instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1848values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1849automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1850In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1851using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1852tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1853reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1854Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1855that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1856each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001857
1858peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001859 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001860 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1861
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001862disabled
1863 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1864 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1865 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1866
1867enable
1868 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1869
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001870peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1871 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1872 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1873 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1874 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1875 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1876 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1877
1878 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1879 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1880
1881 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1882 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1883 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1884 across all peers.
1885
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001886 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1887 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001888
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001889 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001890 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001891 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1892 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1893 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001894
1895 backend mybackend
1896 mode tcp
1897 balance roundrobin
1898 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1899 stick on src
1900
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001901 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1902 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001903
1904
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019053.6. Mailers
1906------------
1907It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1908If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1909in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1910
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001911mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001912 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1913 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1914
1915mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1916 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1917
1918 Example:
1919 mailers mymailers
1920 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1921 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1922
1923 backend mybackend
1924 mode tcp
1925 balance roundrobin
1926
1927 email-alert mailers mymailers
1928 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1929 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1930
1931 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1932 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1933
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001934timeout mail <time>
1935 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1936 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1937 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1938 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1939
1940 Example:
1941 mailers mymailers
1942 timeout mail 20s
1943 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019454. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001946----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001947
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001948Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001949 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001950 - frontend <name>
1951 - backend <name>
1952 - listen <name>
1953
1954A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1955its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1956section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001957section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001958
1959A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1960connections.
1961
1962A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1963to forward incoming connections.
1964
1965A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1966parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1969'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1970case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1971
1972Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1973logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1974proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1975However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1976name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1977
1978Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1979and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001980bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1982modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1983arbitrary criteria.
1984
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001985In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1986a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02001987the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001988
1989 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1990 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1991 between responses and new requests.
1992
1993 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1994 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1995 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02001996 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
1997 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001998
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001999 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2000 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2001 client-facing connection remains open.
2002
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002003 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2004 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002005
2006The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2007frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2008following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002009weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002010
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002011 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002012
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002013 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2014 ----+-----+-----+----
2015 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2016 ----+-----+-----+----
2017 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2018 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2019 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2020 ----+-----+-----+----
2021 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020254.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2026--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002028The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2029limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2030they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2031limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002032marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002033option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002034and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2035with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2036specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002038
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002039 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2040------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2041acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002042appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002043backlog X X X -
2044balance X - X X
2045bind - X X -
2046bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002047block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002048capture cookie - X X -
2049capture request header - X X -
2050capture response header - X X -
2051clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002052compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002053contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2054cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002055declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002056default-server X - X X
2057default_backend X X X -
2058description - X X X
2059disabled X X X X
2060dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002061email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002062email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002063email-alert mailers X X X X
2064email-alert myhostname X X X X
2065email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002066enabled X X X X
2067errorfile X X X X
2068errorloc X X X X
2069errorloc302 X X X X
2070-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2071errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002072force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002073filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002074fullconn X - X X
2075grace X X X X
2076hash-type X - X X
2077http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002078http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002079http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002080http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002081http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002082http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002083http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002084id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002085ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002086load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002087log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002088log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002089log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002090log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002091max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002092maxconn X X X -
2093mode X X X X
2094monitor fail - X X -
2095monitor-net X X X -
2096monitor-uri X X X -
2097option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2098option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2099option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2100option allbackups (*) X - X X
2101option checkcache (*) X - X X
2102option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2103option contstats (*) X X X -
2104option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2105option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002106option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002107-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2108option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002109option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002110option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002111option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002112option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002113option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002114option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002115option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002116option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2117option httpchk X - X X
2118option httpclose (*) X X X X
2119option httplog X X X X
2120option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002121option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002122option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002123option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002124option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2125option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2126option logasap (*) X X X -
2127option mysql-check X - X X
2128option nolinger (*) X X X X
2129option originalto X X X X
2130option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002131option pgsql-check X - X X
2132option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002133option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002134option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002135option smtpchk X - X X
2136option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2137option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2138option splice-request (*) X X X X
2139option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002140option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002141option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2142option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2143-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002144option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002145option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2146option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2147option tcpka X X X X
2148option tcplog X X X X
2149option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002150external-check command X - X X
2151external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002152persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2153rate-limit sessions X X X -
2154redirect - X X X
2155redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2156redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2157reqadd - X X X
2158reqallow - X X X
2159reqdel - X X X
2160reqdeny - X X X
2161reqiallow - X X X
2162reqidel - X X X
2163reqideny - X X X
2164reqipass - X X X
2165reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002166reqitarpit - X X X
2167reqpass - X X X
2168reqrep - X X X
2169-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002170reqtarpit - X X X
2171retries X - X X
2172rspadd - X X X
2173rspdel - X X X
2174rspdeny - X X X
2175rspidel - X X X
2176rspideny - X X X
2177rspirep - X X X
2178rsprep - X X X
2179server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002180server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002181server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002182source X - X X
2183srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002184stats admin - X X X
2185stats auth X X X X
2186stats enable X X X X
2187stats hide-version X X X X
2188stats http-request - X X X
2189stats realm X X X X
2190stats refresh X X X X
2191stats scope X X X X
2192stats show-desc X X X X
2193stats show-legends X X X X
2194stats show-node X X X X
2195stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002196-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2197stick match - - X X
2198stick on - - X X
2199stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002200stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002201stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002202tcp-check connect - - X X
2203tcp-check expect - - X X
2204tcp-check send - - X X
2205tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002206tcp-request connection - X X -
2207tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002208tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002209tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002210tcp-response content - - X X
2211tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002212timeout check X - X X
2213timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002214timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002215timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2216timeout connect X - X X
2217timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2218timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2219timeout http-request X X X X
2220timeout queue X - X X
2221timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002222timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002223timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2224timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002225timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002226transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002227unique-id-format X X X -
2228unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002229use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002230use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002231------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2232 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002233
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022354.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2236---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237
2238This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2239
2240
2241acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2242 Declare or complete an access list.
2243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2244 no | yes | yes | yes
2245 Example:
2246 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2247 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2248 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002250 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251
2252
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002253appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2254 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2257 no | no | yes | yes
2258 Arguments :
2259 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2260 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2261
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002262 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263 checked in each cookie value.
2264
2265 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2266 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2267 milliseconds.
2268
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002269 request-learn
2270 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2271 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2272 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2273 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2274 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2275 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2276
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002277 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2278 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2279 data following this prefix.
2280
2281 Example :
2282 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002284 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2285 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002286
2287 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2288 2 modes are currently supported :
2289 - path-parameters :
2290 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2291 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2292 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2293 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2294 - query-string :
2295 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2296 query string.
2297
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002298 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2299 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2300 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002301
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002302 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2303 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
2305
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002306backlog <conns>
2307 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2309 yes | yes | yes | no
2310 Arguments :
2311 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2312 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002313 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002314
2315 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2316 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2317 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2318 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2319 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2320 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2321 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2322 backlog parameter.
2323
2324 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2325 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2326 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2327
2328 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2329
2330
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002331balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002332balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2335 yes | no | yes | yes
2336 Arguments :
2337 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2338 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2339 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2340 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2341
2342 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2343 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2344 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2345 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002346 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002347 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002348 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2349 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2350 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2351 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2352 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2353 it, so that you don't worry.
2354
2355 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2356 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2357 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2358 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2359 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2360 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2361 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2362 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002364 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2365 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2366 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2367 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2368 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2369 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2370 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2371 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2372
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002373 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002374 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002375 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2376 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002377 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002378 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2379 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2380 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2381 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2382 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002383 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2384 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2385 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2386 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2387 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2388 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2391 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2392 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2393 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2394 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2395 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2396 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2397 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002398 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002400 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2401 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2402 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002404 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2405 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2406 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2407 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2408 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2409 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2410 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2411 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2412 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2413 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2414 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2415 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002417 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002418 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2419 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2420 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2421 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2422 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2423 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2424 URIs start with a leading "/".
2425
2426 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2427 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2428 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2429 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002432 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2433
2434 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002435 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2436 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002437 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2438 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2439 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2440 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002441 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002442 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2443 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002444
2445 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2446 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2447 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2448 server will receive the request.
2449
2450 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2451 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2452 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2453 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2454 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002455 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2456 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2457 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002459 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2460 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2461 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2462 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2463 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002465 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002466 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2467 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2468 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2469
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002470 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2471 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2472 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2473
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002474 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2475 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2476 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2477 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2478 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2479 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2480 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2481 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2482 times.
2483
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002484 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002485 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002486 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2487 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2488 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2489 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2490 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2491 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002492 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002493 used instead.
2494
2495 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2496 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2497 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2498 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2499
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002500 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2501 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2502 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2503
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002504 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002507 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2508 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002509
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002510 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2511 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2512 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513
2514 Examples :
2515 balance roundrobin
2516 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002517 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002518 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2519 balance hdr(host)
2520 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002521
2522 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2523 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002525 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002526 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2527 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2528 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2529 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2530
2531 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2532 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2533 defaults to 16 kB.
2534
2535 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2536 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2537
2538 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2539 Round Robin.
2540
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002541 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002542 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2543 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2544 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2545
2546 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2547
2548 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002549 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002550 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2551 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2552 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002553
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002554 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555
2556
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002557bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2558bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2561 no | yes | yes | no
2562 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002563 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2564 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2565 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2566 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002567 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002568 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2569 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2570 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2571 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2572 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2573 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2574 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002575 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2576 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2577 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2578 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2579 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2580 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2581 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002582 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2583 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2584 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002585 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2586 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2587 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2588 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002589 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2590 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2591 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002592
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002593 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2594 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002595 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2596 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2597 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002598 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2599 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2600 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2601 the range.
2602
2603 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2604 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2605 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2606 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2607 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2608 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2609 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002610 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002611 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002613 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002614 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002615 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2616 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2617 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2618 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2619 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2620 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2621
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002622 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2623 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2624 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2625 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002627 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2628 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2629 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2630 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2631 in a frontend.
2632
2633 Example :
2634 listen http_proxy
2635 bind :80,:443
2636 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002637 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002639 listen http_https_proxy
2640 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002641 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002642
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002643 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2644 bind ipv6@:80
2645 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2646 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2647
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002648 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002649 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002650
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002651 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2652 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2653 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2654 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2655 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2656
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002657 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002658 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002659
2660
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002661bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002662 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2664 yes | yes | yes | yes
2665 Arguments :
2666 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2667 may be used to override a default value.
2668
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002669 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002670 option may be combined with other numbers.
2671
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002672 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002673 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2674 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2675 missing from all processes.
2676
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002677 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002678 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002679 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2680 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2681 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2682 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2683 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002684 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002685
2686 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2687 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2688 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2689 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2690 and 'even' instances.
2691
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002692 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2693 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2694 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2695 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002696
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002697 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2698 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2699
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002700 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2701 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2702 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2703
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002704 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2705 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2706
2707 Example :
2708 listen app_ip1
2709 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002710 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002711
2712 listen app_ip2
2713 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002714 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002715
2716 listen management
2717 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002718 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002719
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002720 listen management
2721 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2722 bind-process 1-4
2723
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002724 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002725
2726
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002727block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2730 no | yes | yes | yes
2731
2732 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2733 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002734 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002735 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002737 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2738 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2739 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002741 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2742 "http-request deny" instead.
2743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744 Example:
2745 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2746 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2747 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002748 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2749 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2750 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002752 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2753 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2754 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755
2756capture cookie <name> len <length>
2757 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2759 no | yes | yes | no
2760 Arguments :
2761 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2762 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2763 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2764 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002765 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766
2767 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2768 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2769 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2770 right if it exceeds <length>.
2771
2772 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2773 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2774 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2775 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2776
2777 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2778 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2779 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2780
2781 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2782 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2783 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002784 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2785 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2786 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787
2788 Example:
2789 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2790
2791 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002792 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
2794
2795capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002796 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2798 no | yes | yes | no
2799 Arguments :
2800 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002801 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002802 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2803 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2804 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2805
2806 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2807 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2808 it exceeds <length>.
2809
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002810 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2812 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002813 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2814 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2815 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2816 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002817 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002818 environments to find where the request came from.
2819
2820 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2821 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2822 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2823 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002825 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2826 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2827 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2828 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2829 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
2831 Example:
2832 capture request header Host len 15
2833 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002834 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002836 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 about logging.
2838
2839
2840capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002841 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2843 no | yes | yes | no
2844 Arguments :
2845 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002846 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002847 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2848 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2849 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2850
2851 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2852 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2853 it exceeds <length>.
2854
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002855 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2857 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2858 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002859 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2860 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2861 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2862 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002864 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2865 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2866 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2867 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2868 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002869
2870 Example:
2871 capture response header Content-length len 9
2872 capture response header Location len 15
2873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002874 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 about logging.
2876
2877
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002878clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2881 yes | yes | yes | no
2882 Arguments :
2883 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2885 as explained at the top of this document.
2886
2887 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2888 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2889 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2890 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2891 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2892 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2893 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2894 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002895 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002896 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002897 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002898
2899 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2900 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2901 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2902 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2903 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2904 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2905
2906 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2907 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2908
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002909 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2910 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002911
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002912compression algo <algorithm> ...
2913compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002914compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002915 Enable HTTP compression.
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 yes | yes | yes | yes
2918 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002919 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2920 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2921 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2922
2923 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002924 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2925 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2926 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002927
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002928 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002929 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002930
2931 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2932 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2933 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2934 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2935 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002936 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002937
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002938 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2939 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2940 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2941 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2942 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2943 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2944 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002945 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002946
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002947 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002948 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002949 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2950 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2951 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2952 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2953 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002954
2955 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2956 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2957 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2958 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2959 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002960 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2961 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2962 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2963 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2964 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002965 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2966 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002967
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002968 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002969 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2970 "Accept-Encoding" header
2971 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002972 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002973 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2974 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002975 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2976 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2977 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2978 "multipart"
2979 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2980 header
2981 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2982 and later
2983 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2984 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002985
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002986 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2987 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002988
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002989 Examples :
2990 compression algo gzip
2991 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002993
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002994contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002995 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 yes | no | yes | yes
2998 Arguments :
2999 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3000 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3001 as explained at the top of this document.
3002
3003 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003004 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003005 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003006 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3008 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3009 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3010
3011 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3012 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3013 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3014 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3015 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3016 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3017
3018 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3019 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3020 instead.
3021
3022 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3023 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3024
3025
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003026cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003027 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3028 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003029 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3032 yes | no | yes | yes
3033 Arguments :
3034 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3035 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3036 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3037 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3038 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3039 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003040 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3042 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3043
3044 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3045 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3046 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3047 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3048 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3049 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003050 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3051 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003052 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003053 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3054 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055
3056 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003057 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003058
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003059 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003060 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3061 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003062 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003063 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3064 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3065 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3066 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3067 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3068 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3069 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3072 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3073 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3074 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3075 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3076 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3077 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3078 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3079 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003080 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003081 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3082 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3083 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003085 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3086 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3087 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003088 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3089 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3090 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3091 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003092 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3093 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3094 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095
3096 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3097 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3098 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3099 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3100 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3101 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3102 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3103 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3104 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3105
3106 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3107 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3108 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3109 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3110 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3111 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3112 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3113 persistence cookie in the cache.
3114 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3115
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003116 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3117 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3118 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3119 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3120 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003121 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003122 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3123 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3124 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3125 they logout.
3126
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003127 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3128 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3129 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3130 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3131
3132 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3133 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3134 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3135 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3136 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3137 this attribute.
3138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003139 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003140 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003141 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3142 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3143 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3144 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3145 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3146 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003147
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003148 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3149 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3150 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3151 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3152 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3153 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3154 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3155 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003156 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003157 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3158 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3159 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3160 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3161 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3162 the site.
3163
3164 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3165 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3166 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3167 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3168 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3169 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3170 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3171 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3172 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3173 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3174 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3175 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3176 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003177 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003178 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3179 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3180
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003181 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3182 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3183 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3184 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3185 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3186 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3189 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3190 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3191 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 Examples :
3194 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3195 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3196 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003197 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003198
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003199 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003201
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003202declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3203 Declares a capture slot.
3204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3205 no | yes | yes | no
3206 Arguments:
3207 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3208
3209 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3210 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3211 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3212 for use in the response.
3213
3214 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003215 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003216 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3217
3218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003219default-server [param*]
3220 Change default options for a server in a backend
3221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3222 yes | no | yes | yes
3223 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003224 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3225 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3226 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3227 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003228
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003229 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003230 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3231
3232 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003233
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235default_backend <backend>
3236 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3238 yes | yes | yes | no
3239 Arguments :
3240 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3241
3242 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3243 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3244 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3245 will catch all undetermined requests.
3246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003247 Example :
3248
3249 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3250 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3251 default_backend dynamic
3252
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003253 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003255
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003256description <string>
3257 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 no | yes | yes | yes
3260 Arguments : string
3261
3262 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3263 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3264 it describes.
3265 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3266
3267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003268disabled
3269 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3271 yes | yes | yes | yes
3272 Arguments : none
3273
3274 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3275 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3276 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3277 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3278 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3279 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3280 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3281
3282 See also : "enabled"
3283
3284
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003285dispatch <address>:<port>
3286 Set a default server address
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003289 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003290
3291 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3292 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3293 during start-up.
3294
3295 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3296 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3297 possible with normal servers.
3298
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003299 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003300 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3301 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3302 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3303 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3304
3305 See also : "server"
3306
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003307
3308dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3309 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3311 yes | no | yes | yes
3312 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3313
3314 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003315 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003316 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3317 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003318 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003319 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003321enabled
3322 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3324 yes | yes | yes | yes
3325 Arguments : none
3326
3327 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3328 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3329
3330 See also : "disabled"
3331
3332
3333errorfile <code> <file>
3334 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | yes | yes | yes
3337 Arguments :
3338 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003339 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3340 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003341
3342 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003343 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003345 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3346 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003347
3348 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3349 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3350 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3351
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003352 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3355 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3356 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3357 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3358
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003359 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3360 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003361 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003362 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3363 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3364 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3367 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3368 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003369 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3371
3372 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3373
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003374 Example :
3375 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003376 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003377 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3378 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3379
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003380
3381errorloc <code> <url>
3382errorloc302 <code> <url>
3383 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3385 yes | yes | yes | yes
3386 Arguments :
3387 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003388 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3389 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003390
3391 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3392 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3393 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3394 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003395 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003396
3397 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3398 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3399 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3400
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003401 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3402
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003403 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3404 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3405 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3406 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003407 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003408 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3409 request.
3410
3411 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3412
3413
3414errorloc303 <code> <url>
3415 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3417 yes | yes | yes | yes
3418 Arguments :
3419 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003420 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3421 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422
3423 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3424 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3425 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3426 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003427 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003428
3429 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3430 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3431 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3432
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003433 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3434
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003435 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3436 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3437 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3438 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003439 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003440
3441 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3442
3443
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003444email-alert from <emailaddr>
3445 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3448 yes | yes | yes | yes
3449
3450 Arguments :
3451
3452 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3453
3454 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3455 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3456
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003457 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003458 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3459 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003460
3461
3462email-alert level <level>
3463 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3464 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 yes | yes | yes | yes
3467
3468 Arguments :
3469
3470 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3471 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3472 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3473
3474 By default level is alert
3475
3476 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3477 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3478 for the proxy.
3479
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003480 Alerts are sent when :
3481
3482 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3483 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3484 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3485 is notice or lower
3486 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3487 and a health check status update occurs
3488
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003489 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3490 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003491 section 3.6 about mailers.
3492
3493
3494email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3495 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3496 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3497 yes | yes | yes | yes
3498
3499 Arguments :
3500
3501 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3502
3503 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3504 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3505
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003506 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3507 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003508
3509
3510email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3511 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3512 mailers.
3513 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3514 yes | yes | yes | yes
3515
3516 Arguments :
3517
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003518 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003519
3520 By default the systems hostname is used.
3521
3522 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3523 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3524 for the proxy.
3525
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003526 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3527 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003528
3529
3530email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003531 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003532 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3533 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 yes | yes | yes | yes
3535
3536 Arguments :
3537
3538 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3539
3540 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3541 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3542
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003543 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003544 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3545
3546
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003547force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3548 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003550 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003551
3552 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3553 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3554 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3555 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3556 marked down for maintenance operations.
3557
3558 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3559 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3560 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3561 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3562 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3563 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3564 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3565 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3566 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3567
3568 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3569 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3570 is used.
3571
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003572 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003573 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003574
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003575
3576filter <name> [param*]
3577 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 no | yes | yes | yes
3580 Arguments :
3581 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3582 referenced in section 9.
3583
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003584 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003585 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003586 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3587 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003588
3589 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3590 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3591
3592 Example:
3593 listen
3594 bind *:80
3595
3596 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3597 filter compression
3598 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3599
3600 compression algo gzip
3601 compression offload
3602
3603 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3604
3605 See also : section 9.
3606
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003608fullconn <conns>
3609 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3611 yes | no | yes | yes
3612 Arguments :
3613 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3614 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3615
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003616 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003617 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003618 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003619 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3620 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3621 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3622 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3623 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003624 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003626 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3627 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003628 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3629 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3630 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003631
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003632 Example :
3633 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3634 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3635 # connections.
3636 backend dynamic
3637 fullconn 10000
3638 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3639 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3640
3641 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3642
3643
3644grace <time>
3645 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003647 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648 Arguments :
3649 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3650 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3651 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3652
3653 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3654 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003655 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003656 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3657
3658 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3659 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3660 simplify it.
3661
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003663hash-balance-factor <factor>
3664 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | no | no | yes
3667 Arguments :
3668 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3669 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3670 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3671
3672 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3673 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3674 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3675 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3676 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3677 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3678 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3679
3680 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3681 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3682 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3683 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3684 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3685
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003686 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3687 consistent hashing mechanism.
3688
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003689 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3690
3691
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003692hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003693 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3695 yes | no | yes | yes
3696 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003697 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3698 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003699
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003700 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3701 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3702 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3703 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3704 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3705 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3706 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3707 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3708 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3709 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003710
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003711 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3712 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3713 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3714 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3715 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3716 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3717 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3718 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3719 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3720 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3721 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3722 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3723 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003724 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3725 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003726
3727 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3728
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003729 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003730 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3731 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3732 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003733 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3734 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3735 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003736
3737 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3738 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003739 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3740 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3741 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3742 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3743
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003744 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3745 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3746 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3747 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3748 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3749 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3750 parameter.
3751
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003752 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3753 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3754 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3755 used on strings.
3756
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003757 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3758
3759 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3760 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3761 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3762 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3763 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3764 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3765 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3766 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3767 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3768 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3769 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3770 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003771
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003772 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3773 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3774 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003775
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003776 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003777
3778
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779http-check disable-on-404
3780 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003782 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003783 Arguments : none
3784
3785 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3786 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3787 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3788 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3789 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3790 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3791 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3792 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003793 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3794 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3795 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3796
3797 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3798
3799
3800http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003801 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003803 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003804 Arguments :
3805 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3806 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003807 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003808 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3809 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3810 details on the supported keywords.
3811
3812 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3813 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3814 with the usual backslash ('\').
3815
3816 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3817 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3818 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3819 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3820 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3821
3822 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003823 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003824 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3825 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3826 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3827
3828 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003829 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003830 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3831 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3832 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3833 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3834
3835 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003836 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003837 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3838 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3839 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3840 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3841 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003842 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003843 trace).
3844
3845 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003846 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003847 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3848 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3849 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3850 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3851 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003852 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003853
3854 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3855 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3856 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3857 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3858 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3859 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3860 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3861 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3862
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003863 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3864 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3865 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3866
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003867 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3868 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3869
3870 Examples :
3871 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003872 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003873
3874 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003875 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003876
3877 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003878 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003879
3880 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003881 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003883 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003884
3885
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003886http-check send-state
3887 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3889 yes | no | yes | yes
3890 Arguments : none
3891
3892 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3893 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3894 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3895 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3896 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3897
3898 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3899 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3900 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3901 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3902 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003903 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3904 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3905 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3906
3907 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3908 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3909 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3910
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003911 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3912 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3913 checked in multiple backends.
3914
3915 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3916 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3917
3918 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3919 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3920 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3921 one fails.
3922
3923 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3924 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3925 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3926
3927 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3928 server's queue.
3929
3930 Example of a header received by the application server :
3931 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3932 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3933
3934 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3935
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003936http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003937 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003938 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003939 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003940 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003941 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3942 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003943 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3944 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04003945 set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003946 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3947 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3948 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003949 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003950 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003951 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003952 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003953 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01003954 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003955 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003956 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01003957 send-spoe-group |
3958 cache-use
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003959 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003960 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003961 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3962
3963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3964 no | yes | yes | yes
3965
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003966 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3967 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3968 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3969 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3970 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003971
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003972 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3973 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3974 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3975
3976 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003977 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3978 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3979 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3980 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003981
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003982 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3983 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3984 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3985 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3986
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003987 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3988 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3989 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003990 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3991 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003992 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3993 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3994 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3995 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3996 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003997 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003998 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3999 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004000
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004001 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
4002 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
4003 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
4004 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
4005 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
4006
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004007 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4008 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
4009 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004010 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
4011 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004012
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004013 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4014 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4015 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004016 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004017 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
4018 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
4019 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4020 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4021
4022 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4023 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4024 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01004025 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
4026 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004027
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004028 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4029 <name>.
4030
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004031 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4032 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4033 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4034 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4035 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4036 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4037 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4038 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
4039
4040 Example:
4041
4042 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4043
4044 applied to:
4045
4046 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4047
4048 outputs:
4049
4050 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4051
4052 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
4053
4054 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4055 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4056 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4057 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4058 header.
4059
4060 Example:
4061
4062 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
4063
4064 applied to:
4065
4066 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4067
4068 outputs:
4069
4070 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4071
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004072 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
4073 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
4074 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
4075 it.
4076
4077 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4078 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4079 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4080 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4081 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4082 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4083
4084 Example :
4085 # prepend the host name before the path
4086 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4087
4088 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4089 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4090 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4091 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4092 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4093 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4094 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4095 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4096
4097 Example :
4098 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4099 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4100
4101 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4102 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4103 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4104 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4105 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4106 "set-query".
4107
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004108 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4109 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4110 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4111 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4112 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4113 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4114 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4115 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4116
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004117 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4118 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4119 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4120 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4121 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4122 another equipment.
4123
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004124 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4125 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4126 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4127 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4128 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004129 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004130 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4131 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4132
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004133 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4134 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4135 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4136 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4137 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4138 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4139 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4140 admin privileges.
4141
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004142 - "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
4143 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to
4144 an integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
4145 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued
4146 requests are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
4147
4148 - "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
4149 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which
4150 converts to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this
4151 range will be truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by
4152 the priority class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given
4153 offset in milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
4154 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4155 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where
4156 the adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as
4157 highest priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value,
4158 where when combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
4159
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004160 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4161 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4162 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4163 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4164 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4165 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4166 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4167 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4168
4169 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4170 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4171 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4172 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4173 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4174 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4175
4176 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4177 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4178 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4179 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4180 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4181 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4182
4183 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4184 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4185 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4186 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4187 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4188 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4189 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4190 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4191 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4192
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004193 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004194 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4195 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4196 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4197 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4198 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4199 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4200 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4201 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4202 request header" for more information.
4203
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004204 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4205 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4206 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4207 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004208 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4209 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004210
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004211 - cache-use <name> :
4212 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4213
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004214 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4215 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02004216 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of
4217 counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set
4218 in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults
4219 to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The
4220 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004221 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4222 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4223 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4224 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4225 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4226 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4227 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4228
4229 These actions take one or two arguments :
4230 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4231 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004232 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004233 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4234
4235 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4236 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4237 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4238 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4239
4240 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4241 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4242 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4243 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4244 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4245 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4246 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4247 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4248
4249 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4250 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4251 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4252 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4253 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4254
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004255 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4256 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4257 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4258 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4259 continues.
4260
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004261 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4262 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4263 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4264 the actions evaluation continues.
4265
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004266 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4267 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4268
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004269 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4270 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4271 inline.
4272
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004273 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4274 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004275 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004276 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4277 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004278 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004279 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004280 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004281 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4282 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004283 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004284 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004285 and '_'.
4286
4287 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4288 followed by some converters.
4289
4290 Example:
4291
4292 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4293
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004294 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4295 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4296
4297 Example:
4298
4299 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4300
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004301 - set-src <expr> :
4302 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4303 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4304 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4305 source IP for privacy.
4306
4307 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4308 followed by some converters.
4309
4310 Example:
4311
4312 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4313 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4314
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004315 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4316 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004317
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004318 - set-src-port <expr> :
4319 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4320 expression.
4321
4322 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4323 followed by some converters.
4324
4325 Example:
4326
4327 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4328 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4329
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004330 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4331 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4332 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004333
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004334 - set-dst <expr> :
4335 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4336 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4337 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4338 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4339 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4340
4341 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4342 followed by some converters.
4343
4344 Example:
4345
4346 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4347 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4348
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004349 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4350 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4351
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004352 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4353 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4354 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4355 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4356
4357 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4358 followed by some converters.
4359
4360 Example:
4361
4362 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4363 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4364
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004365 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4366 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4367 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4368
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004369 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004370 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004371 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4372 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4373 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4374 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4375 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004376 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4377 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004378 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4379 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4380 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4381 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4382 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4383 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4384 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4385
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004386
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004387 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4388 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4389 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4390
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004391 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4392 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4393 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4394 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4395 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4396 SPOE agent name must be used.
4397
4398 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4399
4400 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4401 configuration.
4402
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004403 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4404
4405 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4406 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004407 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4408 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4409
4410 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4411 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4412 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4413 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004414
4415 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004416 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4417 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4418 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004419
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004420 http-request allow if nagios
4421 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4422 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4423 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004424
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004425 Example:
4426 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004427 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004428
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004429 Example:
4430 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4431 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004432 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004433 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4434 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4435 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4436 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4437 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4438 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4439
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004440 Example:
4441 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4442 acl add path /addacl
4443 acl del path /delacl
4444
4445 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4446
4447 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4448 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4449
4450 Example:
4451 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4452 acl setmap path /setmap
4453 acl delmap path /delmap
4454
4455 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4456
4457 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4458 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4459
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004460 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4461 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004462
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004463http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004464 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004465 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004466 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4467 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004468 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004469 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4470 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4471 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4472 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004473 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004474 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004475 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004476 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004477 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004478 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004479 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004480 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004481 send-spoe-group |
4482 cache-store
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004483 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004485 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4486
4487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 no | yes | yes | yes
4489
4490 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4491 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4492 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4493 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4494 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4495 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4496
4497 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4498 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4499 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4500 current section.
4501
4502 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4503 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4504 rules are evaluated.
4505
4506 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4507 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4508 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4509 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4510 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4511 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4512 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4513
4514 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4515 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4516 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4517 external users.
4518
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004519 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4520 <name>.
4521
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004522 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4523 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4524 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4525 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4526 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4527 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4528 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4529 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4530
4531 Example:
4532
4533 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4534
4535 applied to:
4536
4537 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4538
4539 outputs:
4540
4541 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4542
4543 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4544
4545 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4546 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4547 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4548 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4549 header.
4550
4551 Example:
4552
4553 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4554
4555 applied to:
4556
4557 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4558
4559 outputs:
4560
4561 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4562
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004563 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004564 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4565 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4566 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004567
4568 Example:
4569
4570 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4571 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004572 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4573 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004574
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004575 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4576 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4577 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4578 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4579 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4580 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4581 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4582 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4583
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004584 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4585 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4586 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4587 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4588 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4589 another equipment.
4590
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004591 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4592 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4593 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4594 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4595 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004596 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004597 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4598 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4599
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004600 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4601 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4602 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4603 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4604 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4605 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4606 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4607 admin privileges.
4608
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004609 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4610 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4611 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4612 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4613 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4614 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4615 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4616 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4617
4618 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4619 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4620 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4621 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4622 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4623 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4624
4625 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4626 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4627 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4628 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4629 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4630 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4631
4632 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4633 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4634 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4635 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4636 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4637 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4638 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4639 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4640 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4641
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004642 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4643 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4644 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4645 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4646 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4647 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4648 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4649 response header" for more information.
4650
4651 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4652 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4653 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4654 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4655 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004656 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4657 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004658
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004659 - cache-store <name> :
4660 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4661
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004662 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4663 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4664 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4665 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4666 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4667 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4668
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004669 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4670 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4671 inline.
4672
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004673 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4674 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4677 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004678 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004679 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004680 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4682 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004684 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4685 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004686
4687 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4688 followed by some converters.
4689
4690 Example:
4691
4692 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4693
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004694 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4695 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4696
4697 Example:
4698
4699 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4700
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004701 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4702 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4703 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4704 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004705 use of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4706 Layer 6 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004707 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4708
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004709 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4710 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4711 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4712 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4713 continues.
4714
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004715 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4716 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4717 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4718 the actions evaluation continues.
4719
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004720 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4721 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4722
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004723 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004724 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004725 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4726 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4727 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4728 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4729 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004730 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4731 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004732 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4733 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4734 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4735 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4736 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4737 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4738 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4739
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004740 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4741 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4742 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4743 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4744 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4745 SPOE agent name must be used.
4746
4747 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4748
4749 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4750 configuration.
4751
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004752 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4753
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004754 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004755 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004756 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4757 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004758
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004759 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4760 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4761 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4762 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4763
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004764 Example:
4765 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4766
4767 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4768
4769 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4770 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4771
4772 Example:
4773 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4774
4775 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4776
4777 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4778 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4779
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004780 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4781 ACL usage.
4782
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004783
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004784http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4785 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4786
4787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4788 yes | no | yes | yes
4789
4790 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4791 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4792 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4793 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4794 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004795 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004796
4797 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4798
4799 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4800 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4801 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4802 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4803 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4804 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4805 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4806 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4807 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4808 not checking any request past the first one.
4809
4810 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4811 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4812 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4813 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4814 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4815 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4816 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4817
4818 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4819 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4820 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4821 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4822 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4823 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4824 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4825 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4826 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4827 downsides of rare connection failures.
4828
4829 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4830 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4831 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4832 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4833 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4834 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004835 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004836 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4837 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4838 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4839 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4840 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4841
4842 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004843 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4844 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4845 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004846
4847 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004848 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004849
4850 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4851 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4852 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004853 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004854
4855 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4856 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4857 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4858
4859 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4860 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4861 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4862
4863 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4864
4865
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004866http-send-name-header [<header>]
4867 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4868
4869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 yes | no | yes | yes
4871
4872 Arguments :
4873
4874 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4875
4876 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004877 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004878 is added with the header string proved.
4879
4880 See also : "server"
4881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004882id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004883 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 no | yes | yes | yes
4886 Arguments : none
4887
4888 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4889 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4890 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004891
4892
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004893ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4894 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004896 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004897
4898 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4899 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4900 and running).
4901
4902 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4903 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4904 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004905 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004906 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4907
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004908 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4909 "unless" condition is met.
4910
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004911 Example:
4912 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4913 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4914 ignore-persist if url_static
4915
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004916 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4917
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004918load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4919 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | no | yes | yes
4922
4923 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4924 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4925 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004926 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004927 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4928 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4929 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4930 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4931
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004932 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004933 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004934 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004935
4936 Arguments:
4937 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4938 named "server-state-file".
4939
4940 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4941 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4942 name is used as a file name.
4943
4944 none don't load any stat for this backend
4945
4946 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004947 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4948 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4949 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004950 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004951 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004952
4953 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4954 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4955
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004956 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004957
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004958 global
4959 stats socket /tmp/socket
4960 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004961
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004962 defaults
4963 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004964
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004965 backend bk
4966 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4967 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004968
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004969
4970 Then one can run :
4971
4972 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4973
4974 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4975
4976 1
4977 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4978 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4979 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4980
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004981 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004982
4983 global
4984 stats socket /tmp/socket
4985 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4986
4987 defaults
4988 load-server-state-from-file local
4989
4990 backend bk
4991 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4992 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4993
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004994
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004995 Then one can run :
4996
4997 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4998
4999 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5000
5001 1
5002 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5003 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5004 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5005
5006 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5007 "show servers state"
5008
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005009
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005010log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005011log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005012no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005013 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5015 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005016
5017 Prefix :
5018 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5019 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5020 prefix does not allow arguments.
5021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005022 Arguments :
5023 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5024 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5025 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5026 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5027 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5028 parameter.
5029
5030 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5031 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5032
5033 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5034 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5035 standard syslog port).
5036
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005037 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5038 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5039 standard syslog port).
5040
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005041 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5042 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5043 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005044 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005045
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005046 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5047 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005048
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005049 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5050 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5051 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5052 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5053 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5054 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5055 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5056 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5057 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5058 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005059 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005060
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005061 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5062
5063 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5064 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5065 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5066
5067 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5068 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5069 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005070 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5071 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5072 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5073 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5074 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005075
5076 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5077
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005078 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5079 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5080 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005081
5082 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5083 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5084 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5085 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5086
5087 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5088 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005089
5090 Example :
5091 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005092 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5093 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005094 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005095
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005096
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005097log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005098 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5099 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5100 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005101
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005102 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5103 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5104 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5105 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5106 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005107
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005108 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5109 "option httplog" directives.
5110
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005111log-format-sd <string>
5112 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | yes | yes | no
5115
5116 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5117 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5118 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5119 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5120 which covers the log format string in depth.
5121
5122 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5123 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5124
5125 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5126 log format to "rfc5424".
5127
5128 Example :
5129 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5130
5131
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005132log-tag <string>
5133 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | yes | yes | yes
5136
5137 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5138 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5139 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5140 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5141 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5142 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5143 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5144 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5145 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005146
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005147max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5148 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5150 yes | no | yes | yes
5151
5152 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5153 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5154 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5155 servers.
5156
5157 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5158 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5159 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5160 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5161 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005162 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005163 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5164 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5165 picking a different server.
5166
5167 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5168 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5169 even if they have to be queued.
5170
5171 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5172 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5173
5174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005175maxconn <conns>
5176 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5178 yes | yes | yes | no
5179 Arguments :
5180 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5181 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5182 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5183 closes.
5184
5185 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5186 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5187 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5188 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005189 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5190 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5191 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5192 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005193
5194 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5195 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5196 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5197
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005198 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5199
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005200 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5201
5202
5203mode { tcp|http|health }
5204 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 yes | yes | yes | yes
5207 Arguments :
5208 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5209 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5210 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5211 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5212
5213 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5214 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5215 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5216 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5217 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5218
5219 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005220 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5221 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5222 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5223 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5224 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5225 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5226 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005227
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005228 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5229 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5230 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005231
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005232 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005233 defaults http_instances
5234 mode http
5235
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005236 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005237
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005238
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005239monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005240 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005243 Arguments :
5244 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5245 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005246 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005247 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5248 backend and its backup.
5249
5250 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5251 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5252 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5253 servers in a list of backends.
5254
5255 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5256 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5257 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5258 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5259 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5260 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5261 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005262 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5263 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005264
5265 Example:
5266 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005267 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005268 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5269 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5270 monitor-uri /site_alive
5271 monitor fail if site_dead
5272
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005273 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005274
5275
5276monitor-net <source>
5277 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | yes | yes | no
5280 Arguments :
5281 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5282 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5283 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5284 followed by a mask.
5285
5286 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5287 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005288 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005289 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5290
5291 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5292 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5293 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5294 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005295 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5296 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5297 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005298
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005299 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5300 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5301 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5302 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5303 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5304 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005305
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005306 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5307 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005308
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005309 Example :
5310 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5311 frontend www
5312 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5313
5314 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5315
5316
5317monitor-uri <uri>
5318 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | yes | yes | no
5321 Arguments :
5322 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5323 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5324
5325 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5326 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5327 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5328 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5329 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5330 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5331 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5332 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5333
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005334 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5335 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5336 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5337 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5338 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5339 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5340 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5341 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005342
5343 Example :
5344 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5345 frontend www
5346 mode http
5347 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5348
5349 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005351
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005352option abortonclose
5353no option abortonclose
5354 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 yes | no | yes | yes
5357 Arguments : none
5358
5359 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5360 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5361 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5362 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005363 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005364 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5365 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5366 encountered while delivering the response.
5367
5368 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5369 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5370 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5371 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5372 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5373 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005374 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005375 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005376 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005377 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5378 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5379 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5380
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005381 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5382 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005383 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5384 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5385 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5386 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5387 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5388 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005389 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005390
5391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5393
5394 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5395
5396
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005397option accept-invalid-http-request
5398no option accept-invalid-http-request
5399 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5401 yes | yes | yes | no
5402 Arguments : none
5403
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005404 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005405 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005406 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005407 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5408 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5409 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5410 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5411 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005412 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5413 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5414 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5415 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005416 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005417 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005418 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5419 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5420 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005421
5422 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5423 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5424 been confirmed.
5425
5426 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5427 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005428 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5429 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005430 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5431
5432 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5433 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5434
5435 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5436 stats socket.
5437
5438
5439option accept-invalid-http-response
5440no option accept-invalid-http-response
5441 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5443 yes | no | yes | yes
5444 Arguments : none
5445
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005446 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005447 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005448 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005449 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5450 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5451 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5452 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5453 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005454 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5455 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5456 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005457
5458 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5459 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5460 been confirmed.
5461
5462 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5463 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5464 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5465 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5466
5467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5469
5470 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5471 stats socket.
5472
5473
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005474option allbackups
5475no option allbackups
5476 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 yes | no | yes | yes
5479 Arguments : none
5480
5481 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5482 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5483 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5484 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5485 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5486 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5487 order between the backup servers anymore.
5488
5489 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5490 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5491
5492 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5493 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5494
5495
5496option checkcache
5497no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005498 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 yes | no | yes | yes
5501 Arguments : none
5502
5503 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5504 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005505 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005506 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5507 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005508 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005509
5510 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005511 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005512 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005513 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5514 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005515 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005516 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005517 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5518 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005519 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005520 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5521 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005522 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005523 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5524 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5525 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5526 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5527 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5528 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5529 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5530 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5531 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5532
5533 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005534 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005535 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005536 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005537 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5538
5539 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5540 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005541 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005542 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005543
5544 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5545 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5546
5547
5548option clitcpka
5549no option clitcpka
5550 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 yes | yes | yes | no
5553 Arguments : none
5554
5555 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5556 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005557 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005558 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5559
5560 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5561 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5562 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5563 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5564
5565 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5566 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5567 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5568 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5569 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5570
5571 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5572
5573 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5574 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5575 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5576
5577 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5578 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5579
5580 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5581
5582
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005583option contstats
5584 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | no
5587 Arguments : none
5588
5589 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5590 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5591 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5592 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005593 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5594 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5595 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5596 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5597 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005598
5599
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005600option dontlog-normal
5601no option dontlog-normal
5602 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | yes | yes | no
5605 Arguments : none
5606
5607 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5608 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5609 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5610 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5611 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5612 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5613 logged.
5614
5615 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5616 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5617 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005619 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005620 logging.
5621
5622
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005623option dontlognull
5624no option dontlognull
5625 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | yes | yes | no
5628 Arguments : none
5629
5630 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5631 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5632 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5633 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5634 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5635 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005636 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5637 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5638 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005639
5640 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005641 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005642 would not be logged.
5643
5644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5646
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005647 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5648 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005649
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005650
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005651option forceclose (deprecated)
5652no option forceclose (deprecated)
5653 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005654
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005655 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005656
5657
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005658option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005659 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5661 yes | yes | yes | yes
5662 Arguments :
5663 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5664 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005665 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005666 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005667
5668 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5669 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5670 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5671 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5672 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5673 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5674 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005675 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5676 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5677 possible that the client has already brought one.
5678
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005679 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005680 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005681 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005682 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005683 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005684 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005685
5686 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5687 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5688 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5689 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5690 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5691 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5692 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5693
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005694 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5695 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5696 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5697 are under the control of the end-user.
5698
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005699 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005700 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5701 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005702 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5703 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5704 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005705
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005706 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005707 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5708 frontend www
5709 mode http
5710 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5711
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005712 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5713 backend www
5714 mode http
5715 option forwardfor header X-Client
5716
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005717 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005718 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005719
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005720
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005721option http-buffer-request
5722no option http-buffer-request
5723 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5725 yes | yes | yes | yes
5726 Arguments : none
5727
5728 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5729 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5730 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5731 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5732 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5733 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5734 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5735 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005736 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005737 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5738 default.
5739
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005740 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005741
5742
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005743option http-ignore-probes
5744no option http-ignore-probes
5745 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | yes | yes | no
5748 Arguments : none
5749
5750 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5751 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5752 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5753 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5754 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5755 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5756 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5757 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5758 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005759 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5760 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005761 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5762
5763 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5764 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5765 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5766 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5767 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5768 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5769 are often the only way to detect them.
5770
5771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5773
5774 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5775
5776
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005777option http-keep-alive
5778no option http-keep-alive
5779 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 yes | yes | yes | yes
5782 Arguments : none
5783
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005784 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5785 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005786 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5787 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5788 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5789 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
5790 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005791
5792 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5793 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005794 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5795 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5796 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5797 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5798 situations where this option may be useful :
5799
5800 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005801 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005802
5803 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5804 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5805
5806 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5807 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5808 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5809 request.
5810
5811 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5812 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005813 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5814 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5815 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005816
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005817 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5818 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5819 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5820 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5821 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5822 not set.
5823
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005824 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005825 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
5826 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005827
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005828 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005829 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005830 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005831
5832
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005833option http-no-delay
5834no option http-no-delay
5835 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | yes | yes | yes
5838 Arguments : none
5839
5840 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5841 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5842 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5843 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5844 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5845 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5846 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5847 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5848 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5849 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5850 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5851 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5852 affected.
5853
5854 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5855 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5856 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5857 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5858 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5859 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5860 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5861 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5862 latency environments.
5863
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005864 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5865
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005866
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005867option http-pretend-keepalive
5868no option http-pretend-keepalive
5869 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02005871 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005872 Arguments : none
5873
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005874 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005875 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5876 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5877 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5878 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5879 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5880 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5881 consider the response complete.
5882
5883 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5884 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5885 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5886 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005887 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005888 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5889
5890 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5891 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5892 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5893 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5894 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5895 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5896 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5897
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02005898 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
5899 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
5900 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
5901 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
5902 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
5903 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005904
5905 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5906 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5907
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005908 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005909 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005910
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005911
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005912option http-server-close
5913no option http-server-close
5914 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5916 yes | yes | yes | yes
5917 Arguments : none
5918
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005919 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5920 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5921 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5922 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005923 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5924 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
5925 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
5926 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
5927 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
5928 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
5929 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
5930 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
5931 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
5932 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
5933 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005934
5935 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5936 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5937 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5938 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005939 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5940 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005941
5942 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5943 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005944 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
5945 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
5946 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005947
5948 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5949 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5950
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005951 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5952 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005953
5954
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005955option http-tunnel
5956no option http-tunnel
5957 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02005959 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005960 Arguments : none
5961
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005962 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5963 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5964 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5965 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005966 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005967
5968 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005969 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005970 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5971 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5972 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5973 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5974 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5975 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5976 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005977
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02005978 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
5979 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
5980 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
5981 backend.
5982
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005983 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5984 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5985
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005986 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5987 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005988
5989
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005990option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005991no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005992 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | yes | yes | no
5995 Arguments : none
5996
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005997 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005998 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5999 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6000 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6001 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6002 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6003 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6004
6005 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6006 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006007 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6008 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6009 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006010
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006011 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6012 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6013 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6014 front of an existing proxy.
6015
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006016 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6017
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006018 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006019
6020
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006021option httpchk
6022option httpchk <uri>
6023option httpchk <method> <uri>
6024option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6025 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6027 yes | no | yes | yes
6028 Arguments :
6029 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6030 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6031 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6032 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6033 ones.
6034
6035 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6036 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6037 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6038
6039 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6040 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6041 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6042 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6043 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6044
6045 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6046 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6047 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6048 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6049 the lack of any response.
6050
6051 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6052
6053 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6054 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6055 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6056
6057 Examples :
6058 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6059 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6060 backend https_relay
6061 mode tcp
6062 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6063 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6064
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006065 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6066 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6067 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006068
6069
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006070option httpclose
6071no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006072 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6074 yes | yes | yes | yes
6075 Arguments : none
6076
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006077 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6078 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6079 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6080 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006081 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006082
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006083 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6084 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6085 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6086 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6087 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006088
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006089 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6090 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6091 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006092
6093 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6094 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006095 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006096 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6097 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6098 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006099
6100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6102
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006103 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006104
6105
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006106option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006107 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006109 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006110 Arguments :
6111 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6112 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6113 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006114 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006115 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006116
6117 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6118 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6119 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6120 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6121 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6122 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6123 ports.
6124
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006125 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6126 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006127
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006128 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006130 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006131
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006132
6133option http_proxy
6134no option http_proxy
6135 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 yes | yes | yes | yes
6138 Arguments : none
6139
6140 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6141 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6142 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6143 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6144 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6145
6146 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6147 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006148 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6149 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006150
6151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6153
6154 Example :
6155 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6156 backend direct_forward
6157 option httpclose
6158 option http_proxy
6159
6160 See also : "option httpclose"
6161
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006162
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006163option independent-streams
6164no option independent-streams
6165 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | yes | yes | yes
6168 Arguments : none
6169
6170 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6171 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6172 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6173 receive data or not.
6174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006175 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006176 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6177 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6178 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6179 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6180 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6181 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6182 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6183 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6184 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6185 socket buffers.
6186
6187 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6188 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6189 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6190 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6191 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6192
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006193 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006194 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6195 deprecated.
6196
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006197 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006198
6199
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006200option ldap-check
6201 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 yes | no | yes | yes
6204 Arguments : none
6205
6206 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6207 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6208 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6209 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6210
6211 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6212 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6213
6214 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6215 configure it.
6216
6217 Example :
6218 option ldap-check
6219
6220 See also : "option httpchk"
6221
6222
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006223option external-check
6224 Use external processes for server health checks
6225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 yes | no | yes | yes
6227
6228 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6229 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6230 command".
6231
6232 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6233
6234 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6235
6236
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006237option log-health-checks
6238no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006239 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6241 yes | no | yes | yes
6242 Arguments : none
6243
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006244 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6245 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6246 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006247
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006248 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6249 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6250 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6251 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6252 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6253
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006254 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006255 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006256
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006257 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6258 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6259 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006260
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006261
6262option log-separate-errors
6263no option log-separate-errors
6264 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | yes | yes | no
6267 Arguments : none
6268
6269 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6270 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6271 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6272 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6273 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6274 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6275 provides very important information.
6276
6277 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6278 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6279 error logs.
6280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006281 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006282 logging.
6283
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006284
6285option logasap
6286no option logasap
6287 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6289 yes | yes | yes | no
6290 Arguments : none
6291
6292 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6293 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6294 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6295 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6296 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6297 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6298 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006299 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006300 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6301 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6302
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006303 Examples :
6304 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6305 mode http
6306 option httplog
6307 option logasap
6308 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6309
6310 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6311 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6312 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6313 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006315 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006316 logging.
6317
6318
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006319option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006320 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6322 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006323 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006324 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6325 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006326 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006327
6328 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6329 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006330 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006331 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6332 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6333 in the MySQL table, like this :
6334
6335 USE mysql;
6336 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6337 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6338
6339 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006340 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006341 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6342 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6343 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6344 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6345 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6346 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6347 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6348
6349 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6350 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006351
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006352 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006353
6354 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6355 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6356 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6357 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006358 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6359 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006360
6361 See also: "option httpchk"
6362
6363
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006364option nolinger
6365no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006366 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6368 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006369 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006371 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006372 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6373 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6374 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6375 connections.
6376
6377 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6378 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6379 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6380 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6381 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6382 this too.
6383
6384 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6385 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6386 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6387
6388 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6389 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6390 for servers.
6391
6392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6394
6395
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006396option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6397 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | yes | yes | yes
6400 Arguments :
6401 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6402 matching <network>
6403 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6404 header name.
6405
6406 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6407 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6408 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6409 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6410 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6411 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6412 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6413 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6414 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6415 possible that the client has already brought one.
6416
6417 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6418 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6419 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6420 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6421 header and requires different one.
6422
6423 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6424 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6425 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6426 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6427 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6428 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6429 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6430
6431 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6432 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6433 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6434 both are defined.
6435
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006436 Examples :
6437 # Original Destination address
6438 frontend www
6439 mode http
6440 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6441
6442 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6443 backend www
6444 mode http
6445 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6446
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006447 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006448
6449
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006450option persist
6451no option persist
6452 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006455 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006456
6457 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6458 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6459 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6460 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6461 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6462 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6463 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6464 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6465 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6466 redirected to another valid server.
6467
6468 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6469 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6470
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006471 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006472
6473
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006474option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6475 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6477 yes | no | yes | yes
6478 Arguments :
6479 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6480 PostgreSQL server.
6481
6482 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6483 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6484 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6485 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6486
6487 See also: "option httpchk"
6488
6489
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006490option prefer-last-server
6491no option prefer-last-server
6492 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 yes | no | yes | yes
6495 Arguments : none
6496
6497 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6498 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6499 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6500 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6501 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6502 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6503 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6504 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6505 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006506 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6507 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6508 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6509 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6510 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6511 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6512 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006513
6514 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6515 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6516
6517 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6518
6519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006520option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006521option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006522no option redispatch
6523 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6525 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006526 Arguments :
6527 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6528 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6529 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006530 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006531 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006532 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006533 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6534 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6535 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006537
6538 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6539 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6540 be able to access the service anymore.
6541
6542 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6543 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6544
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006545 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006546 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6547 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006549 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6550 "redisp" keywords.
6551
6552 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6553 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6554
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006555 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006556
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006557
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006558option redis-check
6559 Use redis health checks for server testing
6560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6561 yes | no | yes | yes
6562 Arguments : none
6563
6564 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6565 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6566 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6567 find the "+PONG" response message.
6568
6569 Example :
6570 option redis-check
6571
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006572 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006573
6574
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006575option smtpchk
6576option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6577 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6579 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006580 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006581 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006582 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006583 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6584
6585 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6586 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6587 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6588
6589 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6590 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6591 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6592 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6593 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6594 dead server.
6595
6596 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6597 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006598 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006599 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6600
6601 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6602 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6603 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6604 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006605 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006606
6607 Example :
6608 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6609
6610 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006613option socket-stats
6614no option socket-stats
6615
6616 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6618 yes | yes | yes | no
6619
6620 Arguments : none
6621
6622
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006623option splice-auto
6624no option splice-auto
6625 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6627 yes | yes | yes | yes
6628 Arguments : none
6629
6630 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6631 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006632 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006633 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006634 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006635 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6636 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6637 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6638 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6639
6640 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6641 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6642 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6643 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6644 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6645 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6646 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6647 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6648 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6649 keyword.
6650
6651 Example :
6652 option splice-auto
6653
6654 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6655 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6656
6657 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6658 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6659
6660
6661option splice-request
6662no option splice-request
6663 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | yes | yes | yes
6666 Arguments : none
6667
6668 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006669 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006670 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6671 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6672 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6673 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6674
6675 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6676
6677 Example :
6678 option splice-request
6679
6680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6682
6683 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6684 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6685
6686
6687option splice-response
6688no option splice-response
6689 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 yes | yes | yes | yes
6692 Arguments : none
6693
6694 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006695 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006696 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6697 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6698 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6699 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6700
6701 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6702
6703 Example :
6704 option splice-response
6705
6706 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6707 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6708
6709 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6710 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6711
6712
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006713option spop-check
6714 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6716 no | no | no | yes
6717 Arguments : none
6718
6719 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6720 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6721 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6722 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6723
6724 Example :
6725 option spop-check
6726
6727 See also : "option httpchk"
6728
6729
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006730option srvtcpka
6731no option srvtcpka
6732 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6734 yes | no | yes | yes
6735 Arguments : none
6736
6737 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6738 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006739 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006740 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6741
6742 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6743 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6744 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6745 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6746
6747 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6748 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6749 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6750 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6751 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6752
6753 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6754
6755 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6756 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6757 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6758
6759 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6760 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6761
6762 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6763
6764
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006765option ssl-hello-chk
6766 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6768 yes | no | yes | yes
6769 Arguments : none
6770
6771 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6772 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6773 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6774 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6775 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6776 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6777 hello message.
6778
6779 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6780 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6781 messages, which is appreciable.
6782
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006783 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6784 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6785 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006786
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006787 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6788
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006789
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006790option tcp-check
6791 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | no | yes | yes
6794
6795 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6796 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6797
6798 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6799 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6800 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6801
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006802 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006803 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6804 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6805 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6806 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6807 only.
6808
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006809 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006810 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6811 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6812 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6813 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6814
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006815 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006816 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
6817 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006818 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006819 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6820 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6821 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6822 the respective protocols.
6823 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006824 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006825
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006826 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6827 script.
6828
6829 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6830 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6831 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6832 The "comment" is of course optional.
6833
6834
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006835 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006836 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006837 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006838 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006839
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006840 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006841 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006842 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006843
6844 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6845 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006846 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006847 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006848 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006849 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006850 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006851 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006852 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6853 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006854 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006855 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6856 tcp-check expect string +OK
6857
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006858 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006859 (send many headers before analyzing)
6860 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006861 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006862 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6863 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6864 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6865 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006866 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006867
6868
6869 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6870
6871
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006872option tcp-smart-accept
6873no option tcp-smart-accept
6874 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6876 yes | yes | yes | no
6877 Arguments : none
6878
6879 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6880 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6881 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6882 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6883 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6884 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6885
6886 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6887 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6888 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6889 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6890
6891 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6892 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6893 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006894 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006895
6896 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6897 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6898 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6899
6900 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6901 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6902 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6903
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006904 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6905
6906
6907option tcp-smart-connect
6908no option tcp-smart-connect
6909 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6911 yes | no | yes | yes
6912 Arguments : none
6913
6914 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6915 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6916 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6917 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6918 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6919
6920 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6921 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6922 complex.
6923
6924 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6925 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6926 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6927
6928 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6929 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6930
6931 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6932
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006933
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006934option tcpka
6935 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6937 yes | yes | yes | yes
6938 Arguments : none
6939
6940 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6941 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006942 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006943 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6944
6945 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6946 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6947 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6948 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6949
6950 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6951 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6952 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6953 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6954 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6955
6956 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6957
6958 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6959 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6960 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6961 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6962 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6963 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6964 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6965 backends.
6966
6967 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6968
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006969
6970option tcplog
6971 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006973 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006974 Arguments : none
6975
6976 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6977 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6978 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6979 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6980 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6981 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6982 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6983 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6984
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006985 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006987 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006988
6989
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006990option transparent
6991no option transparent
6992 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006994 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006995 Arguments : none
6996
6997 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6998 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6999 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7000 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7001 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7002 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7003 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7004 appropriate server.
7005
7006 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7007 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7008
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007009 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007010 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007011
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007012
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007013external-check command <command>
7014 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7016 yes | no | yes | yes
7017
7018 Arguments :
7019 <command> is the external command to run
7020
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007021 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7022
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007023 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007024
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007025 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7026 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7027 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7028 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7029 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7030 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007031
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007032 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7033
7034 Environment variables :
7035 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7036 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7037
7038 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7039
7040 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7041
7042 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7043 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7044 for a UNIX socket).
7045
7046 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7047
7048 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7049
7050 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7051
7052 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7053
7054 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7055
7056 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7057 socket).
7058
7059 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7060 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7061
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007062 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7063 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7064 failed.
7065
7066 Example :
7067 external-check command /bin/true
7068
7069 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7070
7071
7072external-check path <path>
7073 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 yes | no | yes | yes
7076
7077 Arguments :
7078 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7079
7080 The default path is "".
7081
7082 Example :
7083 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7084
7085 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7086 "external-check command"
7087
7088
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007089persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007090persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007091 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7093 yes | no | yes | yes
7094 Arguments :
7095 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007096 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7097 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007098
7099 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7100 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007101 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007102 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7103 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7104 forwarded to this server.
7105
7106 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7107 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7108 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007109 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007110 a single "listen" section.
7111
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007112 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7113 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7114 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7115
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007116 Example :
7117 listen tse-farm
7118 bind :3389
7119 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7120 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7121 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7122 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7123 persist rdp-cookie
7124 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007125 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007126 balance rdp-cookie
7127 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7128 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7129
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007130 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7131 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007132
7133
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007134rate-limit sessions <rate>
7135 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7137 yes | yes | yes | no
7138 Arguments :
7139 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7140 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7141
7142 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7143 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7144 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7145 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7146 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7147 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7148
7149 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7150 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7151 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7152 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7153
7154 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7155 listen smtp
7156 mode tcp
7157 bind :25
7158 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007159 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007160
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007161 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7162 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7163 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007164
7165 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7166
7167
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007168redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7169redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7170redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007171 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7173 no | yes | yes | yes
7174
7175 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007176 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007177
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007178 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007179 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007180 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7181 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7182 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007183
7184 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7185 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7186 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7187 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7188 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007189 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7190 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7191 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7192 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007193
7194 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7195 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7196 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7197 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7198 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7199 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007200 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007201 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007202 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7203 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7204 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007205
7206 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007207 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7208 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7209 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007210 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007211 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7212 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7213 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7214 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007215
7216 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007217 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007218
7219 - "drop-query"
7220 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7221 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7222 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7223 with a location-type redirect.
7224
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007225 - "append-slash"
7226 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7227 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7228 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7229 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7230
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007231 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7232 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7233 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7234 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7235 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7236 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7237 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7238
7239 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7240 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7241 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7242 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7243 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7244 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7245 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007246
7247 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7248 acl clear dst_port 80
7249 acl secure dst_port 8080
7250 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007251 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007252 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007253 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7254
7255 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007256 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7257 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7258 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007259 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007260
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007261 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7262 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7263 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7264
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007265 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007266 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007267
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007268 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007269 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7270 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7271 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007273 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007274
7275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007276redisp (deprecated)
7277redispatch (deprecated)
7278 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7280 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007281 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007282
7283 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7284 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7285 be able to access the service anymore.
7286
7287 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7288 redistribute them to a working server.
7289
7290 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7291 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7292 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007294 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7295 "option redispatch" instead.
7296
7297 See also : "option redispatch"
7298
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007299
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007300reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007301 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7303 no | yes | yes | yes
7304 Arguments :
7305 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7306 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007307 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007308
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007309 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7310 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7311
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007312 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7313 the last header of an HTTP request.
7314
7315 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7316 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7317 responses.
7318
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007319 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7320 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7321 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7322
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007323 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7324 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007325
7326
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007327reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7328reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007329 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7331 no | yes | yes | yes
7332 Arguments :
7333 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7334 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7335 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7336 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7337 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7338 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7339 ignores case.
7340
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007341 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7342 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7343
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007344 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7345 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7346 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7347 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007348 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007349
7350 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7351 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7352
7353 Example :
7354 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7355 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7356 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7357
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007358 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7359 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007360
7361
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007362reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7363reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007364 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 no | yes | yes | yes
7367 Arguments :
7368 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7369 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7370 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7371 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7372 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7373 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007375 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7376 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7377
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007378 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7379 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7380 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7381 next servers.
7382
7383 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7384 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7385 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7386
7387 Example :
7388 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7389 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7390 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7391
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007392 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7393 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007394
7395
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007396reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7397reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007398 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 no | yes | yes | yes
7401 Arguments :
7402 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7403 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7404 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7405 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7406 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7407 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7408 case.
7409
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007410 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7411 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7412
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007413 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7414 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7415 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7416 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007417 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007418
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007419 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007420 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007421 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007422
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007423 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7424 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7425
7426 Example :
7427 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7428 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7429 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7430
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007431 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7432 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007433
7434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007435reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7436reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007437 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7439 no | yes | yes | yes
7440 Arguments :
7441 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7442 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7443 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7444 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7445 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7446 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7447 case.
7448
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007449 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7450 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7451
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007452 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7453 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7454 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7455 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7456
7457 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7458 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7459
7460 Example :
7461 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7462 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7463 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7464 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7465
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007466 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7467 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007468
7469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007470reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7471reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007472 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7474 no | yes | yes | yes
7475 Arguments :
7476 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7477 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7478 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7479 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7480 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7481 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7482
7483 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7484 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7485 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7486 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007487 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007488
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007489 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7490 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007492 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7493 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7494 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7495
7496 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7497 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7498 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7499 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7500 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7501
7502 Example :
7503 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007504 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007505 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7506 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7507
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007508 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7509 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007510
7511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007512reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7513reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007514 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7516 no | yes | yes | yes
7517 Arguments :
7518 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7519 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7520 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7521 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7522 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7523 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7524 ignores case.
7525
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007526 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7527 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7528
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007529 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7530 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007531 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7532 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7533 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007534 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7535 not set.
7536
7537 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7538 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7539 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7540 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7541 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7542
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007543 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007544 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007545 # block all others.
7546 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7547 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7548
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007549 # block bad guys
7550 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7551 reqitarpit . if badguys
7552
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007553 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7554 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007555
7556
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007557retries <value>
7558 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7560 yes | no | yes | yes
7561 Arguments :
7562 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7563 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7564 default value is 3.
7565
7566 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7567 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7568 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7569
7570 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007571 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7572 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007573
7574 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7575 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7576
7577 See also : "option redispatch"
7578
7579
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007580rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007581 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7583 no | yes | yes | yes
7584 Arguments :
7585 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7586 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007587 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007588
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007589 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7590 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7591
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007592 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7593 the last header of an HTTP response.
7594
7595 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7596 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7597 responses.
7598
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007599 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7600 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007601
7602
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007603rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7604rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007605 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7607 no | yes | yes | yes
7608 Arguments :
7609 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7610 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7611 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7612 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7613 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7614 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7615 ignores case.
7616
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007617 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7618 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7619
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007620 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7621 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007622 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007623 client.
7624
7625 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7626 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7627 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7628
7629 Example :
7630 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007631 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007632
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007633 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7634 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007635
7636
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007637rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7638rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007639 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7641 no | yes | yes | yes
7642 Arguments :
7643 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7644 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7645 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7646 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7647 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7648 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7649 ignores case.
7650
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007651 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7652 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7653
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007654 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7655 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7656 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7657 case-sensitive.
7658
7659 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007660 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7661 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7662 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007663
7664 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7665 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7666
7667 Example :
7668 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7669 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7670
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007671 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7672 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007673
7674
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007675rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7676rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007677 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 no | yes | yes | yes
7680 Arguments :
7681 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7682 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7683 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7684 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7685 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7686 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7687 ignores case.
7688
7689 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7690 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7691 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7692 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007694
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007695 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7696 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7697
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007698 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7699 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7700 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7701
7702 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7703 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7704 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7705 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7706 are not case-sensitive.
7707
7708 Example :
7709 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7710 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7711
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007712 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7713 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007714
7715
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007716server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007717 Declare a server in a backend
7718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7719 no | no | yes | yes
7720 Arguments :
7721 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007722 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007723 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007724
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007725 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7726 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7727 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7728 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007729 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7730 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7731 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7732 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7733 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007734 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7735 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7736 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7737 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7738 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7739 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7740 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007741 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007742 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7743 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7744 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7745 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7746 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7747 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007748 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7749 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007750 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7751 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007752
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007753 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007754 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7755 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7756 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7757 adding this value to the client's port.
7758
7759 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7760 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007761 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007762
7763 Examples :
7764 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7765 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007766 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007767 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7768 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7769 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007770
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007771 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7772 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7773 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7774 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7775 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7776
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007777 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7778 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007779
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007780server-state-file-name [<file>]
7781 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7782 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7783 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7784 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7785 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7786 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7787
7788 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7789 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7790
7791 global
7792 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7793
7794 backend bk
7795 load-server-state-from-file
7796
7797 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7798 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007799
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007800server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7801 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7802 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7804 no | no | yes | yes
7805
7806 Arguments:
7807 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7808
7809 <num | range>
7810 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7811 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7812 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7813 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7814
7815 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7816
7817 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7818
7819 <params*>
7820 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7821 keyword.
7822
7823 Examples:
7824 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7825 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7826 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7827
7828 # or
7829 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7830
7831 # would be equivalent to:
7832 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7833 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7834 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7835
7836
7837
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007838source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007839source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007840source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007841 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7843 yes | no | yes | yes
7844 Arguments :
7845 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7846 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007847
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007848 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007849 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7850 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7851 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7852 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7853 supported prefixes are :
7854 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7855 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7856 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007857 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007858 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7859 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007860
7861 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7862 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007863 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7864 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7865 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007866
7867 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7868 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7869 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7870 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7871 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7872 <addr>.
7873
7874 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7875 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7876 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7877 port.
7878
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007879 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7880 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7881 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7882 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007883 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007884 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7885 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7886 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7887 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7888 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7889 HTTP header.
7890
7891 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7892 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007893 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007894 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7895 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7896 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7897 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7898 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7899 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7900 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7901
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007902 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7903 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7904 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7905 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7906 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7907 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7908
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007909 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7910 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7911 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7912 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7913
7914 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7915 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7916 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7917 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7918 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7919 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7920
7921 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7922 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7923 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7924 there are two methods :
7925
7926 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7927 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7928 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7929 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7930 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7931 of the client ranges may be used.
7932
7933 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7934 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7935 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7936 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7937 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7938 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7939 same session.
7940
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007941 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7942 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7943 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007944 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007945
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007946 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7947
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007948 Examples :
7949 backend private
7950 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7951 source 192.168.1.200
7952
7953 backend transparent_ssl1
7954 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7955 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7956
7957 backend transparent_ssl2
7958 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7959 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7960 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7961
7962 backend transparent_ssl3
7963 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7964 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7965 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7966
7967 backend transparent_smtp
7968 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7969 # with Tproxy version 4.
7970 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7971
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007972 backend transparent_http
7973 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7974 # proxy.
7975 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007977 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007978 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007980
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007981srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7982 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7984 yes | no | yes | yes
7985 Arguments :
7986 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7987 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7988 as explained at the top of this document.
7989
7990 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7991 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7992 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7993 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7994 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7995 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7996 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7997
7998 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7999 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8000 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8001 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8002 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008003 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008004 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008005 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008006
8007 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8008 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8009 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8010 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8011 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8012 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8013
8014 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8015 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8016
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008017 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8018 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008019
8020
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008021stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8022 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008024 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008025
8026 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8027 matched.
8028
8029 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8030 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8031
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008032 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8033 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008034 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008035
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008036 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8037 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8038 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8039 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008040
8041 Example :
8042 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8043 backend stats_localhost
8044 stats enable
8045 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8046
8047 Example :
8048 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8049 backend stats_auth
8050 stats enable
8051 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8052 stats admin if TRUE
8053
8054 Example :
8055 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8056 userlist stats-auth
8057 group admin users admin
8058 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8059 group readonly users haproxy
8060 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8061
8062 backend stats_auth
8063 stats enable
8064 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8065 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8066 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8067 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8068
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008069 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8070 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8071 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008072
8073
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008074stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8075 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008077 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008078 Arguments :
8079 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8080
8081 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8082
8083 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8084 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8085 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8086 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8087 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8088 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8089
8090 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8091 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8092 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008093 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008094
8095 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8096 report using "stats scope".
8097
8098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8100 unobvious parameters.
8101
8102 Example :
8103 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8104 backend public_www
8105 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8106 stats enable
8107 stats hide-version
8108 stats scope .
8109 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008110 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008111 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8112 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8113
8114 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8115 backend private_monitoring
8116 stats enable
8117 stats uri /admin?stats
8118 stats refresh 5s
8119
8120 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8121
8122
8123stats enable
8124 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008127 Arguments : none
8128
8129 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8130 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8131 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8132 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8133 - stats auth : no authentication
8134 - stats scope : no restriction
8135
8136 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8137 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8138 unobvious parameters.
8139
8140 Example :
8141 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8142 backend public_www
8143 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8144 stats enable
8145 stats hide-version
8146 stats scope .
8147 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008148 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008149 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8150 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8151
8152 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8153 backend private_monitoring
8154 stats enable
8155 stats uri /admin?stats
8156 stats refresh 5s
8157
8158 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8159
8160
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008161stats hide-version
8162 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008164 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008165 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008166
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008167 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8168 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8169 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8170 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8171 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8172 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008173
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008174 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8175 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8176 unobvious parameters.
8177
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008178 Example :
8179 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8180 backend public_www
8181 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008182 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008183 stats hide-version
8184 stats scope .
8185 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008186 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008187 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8188 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008189
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008190 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8191 backend private_monitoring
8192 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008193 stats uri /admin?stats
8194 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008195
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008196 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008197
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008198
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008199stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8200 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8201 Access control for statistics
8202
8203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8204 no | no | yes | yes
8205
8206 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8207 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8208 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8209 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8210 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8211 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8212
8213 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8214 instance.
8215
8216 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8217 about ACL usage.
8218
8219
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008220stats realm <realm>
8221 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008224 Arguments :
8225 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8226 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8227 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8228
8229 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8230 using a backslash ('\').
8231
8232 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8233 only related to authentication.
8234
8235 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8236 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8237 unobvious parameters.
8238
8239 Example :
8240 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8241 backend public_www
8242 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8243 stats enable
8244 stats hide-version
8245 stats scope .
8246 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008247 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008248 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8249 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8250
8251 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8252 backend private_monitoring
8253 stats enable
8254 stats uri /admin?stats
8255 stats refresh 5s
8256
8257 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8258
8259
8260stats refresh <delay>
8261 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008263 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008264 Arguments :
8265 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8266 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8267 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8268 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8269 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8270 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8271
8272 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8273 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8274 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8275 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8276
8277 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8278 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8279 unobvious parameters.
8280
8281 Example :
8282 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8283 backend public_www
8284 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8285 stats enable
8286 stats hide-version
8287 stats scope .
8288 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008289 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008290 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8291 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8292
8293 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8294 backend private_monitoring
8295 stats enable
8296 stats uri /admin?stats
8297 stats refresh 5s
8298
8299 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8300
8301
8302stats scope { <name> | "." }
8303 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008305 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008306 Arguments :
8307 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8308 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8309 section in which the statement appears.
8310
8311 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8312 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8313 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8314 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8315 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8316 exists.
8317
8318 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8319 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8320 unobvious parameters.
8321
8322 Example :
8323 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8324 backend public_www
8325 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8326 stats enable
8327 stats hide-version
8328 stats scope .
8329 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008330 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008331 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8332 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8333
8334 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8335 backend private_monitoring
8336 stats enable
8337 stats uri /admin?stats
8338 stats refresh 5s
8339
8340 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8341
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008342
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008343stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008344 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008346 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008347
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008348 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008349 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8350
8351 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8352 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8353
8354 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8355 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008356 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008357
8358 Example :
8359 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8360 backend private_monitoring
8361 stats enable
8362 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8363 stats uri /admin?stats
8364 stats refresh 5s
8365
8366 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8367 global section.
8368
8369
8370stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008371 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8373 yes | yes | yes | yes
8374 Arguments : none
8375
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008376 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008377 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8378 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8379 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8380 - IP (socket, server)
8381 - cookie (backend, server)
8382
8383 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8384 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008385 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008386
8387 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8388
8389
8390stats show-node [ <name> ]
8391 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008393 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008394 Arguments:
8395 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8396 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8397
8398 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8399 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008400 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008401
8402 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8403 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8404 unobvious parameters.
8405
8406 Example:
8407 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8408 backend private_monitoring
8409 stats enable
8410 stats show-node Europe-1
8411 stats uri /admin?stats
8412 stats refresh 5s
8413
8414 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8415 section.
8416
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008417
8418stats uri <prefix>
8419 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008421 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008422 Arguments :
8423 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8424 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8425 query string.
8426
8427 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8428 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8429 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8430 possible to reach it in the application.
8431
8432 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008433 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008434 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8435 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8436 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8437 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8438
8439 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8440 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8441 an address or a port to statistics only.
8442
8443 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8444 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8445 unobvious parameters.
8446
8447 Example :
8448 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8449 backend public_www
8450 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8451 stats enable
8452 stats hide-version
8453 stats scope .
8454 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008455 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008456 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8457 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8458
8459 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8460 backend private_monitoring
8461 stats enable
8462 stats uri /admin?stats
8463 stats refresh 5s
8464
8465 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8466
8467
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008468stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8469 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008471 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008472
8473 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008474 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008475 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008476 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008477 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8478
8479 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8480 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8481 the "stick-table" statement.
8482
8483 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8484 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8485 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8486 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8487 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8488
8489 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8490 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8491 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8492 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8493 transformation rules.
8494
8495 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8496 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8497 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8498 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8499 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8500 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8501 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8502
8503 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8504 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8505 ACL based conditions.
8506
8507 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8508 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8509 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8510 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8511
8512 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8513 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8514 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8515 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8516
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008517 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8518 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008519 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008520
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008521 Example :
8522 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8523 # last 30 minutes
8524 backend pop
8525 mode tcp
8526 balance roundrobin
8527 stick store-request src
8528 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8529 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8530 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8531
8532 backend smtp
8533 mode tcp
8534 balance roundrobin
8535 stick match src table pop
8536 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8537 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8538
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008539 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008540 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008541
8542
8543stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8544 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8546 no | no | yes | yes
8547
8548 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8549 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8550 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8551 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8552
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008553 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8554 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008555 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008556
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008557 Examples :
8558 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008559 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008560
8561 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8562 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8563 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8564
8565
8566 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8567 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8568 backend http
8569 mode http
8570 balance roundrobin
8571 stick on src table https
8572 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8573 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8574 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8575
8576 backend https
8577 mode tcp
8578 balance roundrobin
8579 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8580 stick on src
8581 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8582 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8583
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008584 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008585
8586
8587stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8588 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8590 no | no | yes | yes
8591
8592 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008593 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008594 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008595 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008596 server is selected.
8597
8598 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8599 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8600 the "stick-table" statement.
8601
8602 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8603 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8604 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8605 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8606 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8607 address.
8608
8609 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8610 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8611 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8612 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8613 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8614 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8615 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8616 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8617 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8618 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8619
8620 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8621 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8622 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8623 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8624 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8625 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8626 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8627
8628 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8629 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8630 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8631 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8632
8633 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8634 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8635 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8636 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8637 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8638 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008639 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8640 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8641 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8642 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8643 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8644 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008645
8646 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8647 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8648 the request.
8649
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008650 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8651 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008652 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008653
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008654 Example :
8655 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8656 # last 30 minutes
8657 backend pop
8658 mode tcp
8659 balance roundrobin
8660 stick store-request src
8661 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8662 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8663 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8664
8665 backend smtp
8666 mode tcp
8667 balance roundrobin
8668 stick match src table pop
8669 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8670 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8671
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008672 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008673 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008674
8675
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008676stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008677 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8678 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008679 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008681 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008682
8683 Arguments :
8684 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8685 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8686 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8687 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8688
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008689 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8690 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8691 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8692 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8693
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008694 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8695 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8696 instance.
8697
8698 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8699 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8700 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8701 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8702 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8703 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008704 to 32 characters.
8705
8706 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8707 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8708 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008709 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008710 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8711 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008712
8713 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008714 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8715 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008716 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8717 increase.
8718
8719 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008720 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8721 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8722 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008723
8724 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8725 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8726 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8727 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008728 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008729 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8730 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8731 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8732 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8733 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8734 parameter (see below).
8735
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008736 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8737 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8738 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8739 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8740 soft restart.
8741
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008742 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8743 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008744
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008745 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8746 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8747 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8748 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008749 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008750 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008751 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8752 if not expiration delay is specified.
8753
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008754 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8755 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8756 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8757 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008758 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8759 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8760 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8761 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8762 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8763 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8764 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8765 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8766 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8767 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8768 types and their arguments.
8769
8770 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8771 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8772 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8773 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8774
8775 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8776 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8777 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008778 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008779
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008780 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8781 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8782 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008783 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008784 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008785 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008786
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008787 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8788 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8789 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8790 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8791
8792 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8793 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8794 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8795 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8796 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8797 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8798
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008799 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8800 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8801 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8802 they were received.
8803
8804 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8805 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8806 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8807 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8808 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8809
8810 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8811 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8812 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8813 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8814 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8815
8816 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8817 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8818 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8819
8820 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8821 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8822 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8823 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8824 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8825
8826 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8827 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8828 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8829 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8830 the client side.
8831
8832 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8833 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8834 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8835 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8836 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8837 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8838 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8839
8840 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8841 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8842 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8843 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8844 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8845 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008846 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008847
8848 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8849 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8850 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8851 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8852 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8853 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8854
8855 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008856 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008857 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8858 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8859
8860 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8861 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8862 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8863 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8864 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8865 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8866 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8867 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8868 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8869 recommended for better fairness.
8870
8871 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008872 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008873 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8874 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8875
8876 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8877 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8878 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8879 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8880 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8881 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8882 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8883 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8884 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8885 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008886
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008887 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8888 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008889 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8890 reference it.
8891
8892 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8893 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008894 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8895 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8896 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008897
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008898 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8899 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8900 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8901 something that can be ignored.
8902
8903 Example:
8904 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8905 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8906 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8907 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8908
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008909 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008910 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008911
8912
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008913stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008914 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8916 no | no | yes | yes
8917
8918 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008919 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008920 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008921 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008922 server is selected.
8923
8924 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8925 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8926 the "stick-table" statement.
8927
8928 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8929 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8930 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8931 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8932
8933 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8934 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8935 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8936 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8937 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8938 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008939 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008940 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8941 rules.
8942
8943 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8944 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8945 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8946 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8947 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8948 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8949 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8950
8951 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8952 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8953 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8954 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8955
8956 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8957 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8958 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8959 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8960 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8961 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008962 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8963 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8964 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8965 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8966 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8967 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8968 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8969 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8970 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008971
8972 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8973
8974 Example :
8975 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8976 backend https
8977 mode tcp
8978 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008979 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008980 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008981
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008982 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8983 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8984
8985 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8986 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8987 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8988
8989 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8990 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008991
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008992 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8993 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8994 # at offset 44.
8995
8996 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8997 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8998
8999 # Learn on response if server hello.
9000 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009001
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009002 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9003 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9004
9005 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9006 extraction.
9007
9008
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009009tcp-check connect [params*]
9010 Opens a new connection
9011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9012 no | no | yes | yes
9013
9014 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9015 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9016 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9017
9018 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9019 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9020 of the sequence.
9021
9022 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9023 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9024 do.
9025
9026 Parameters :
9027 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9028 use the TCP connection.
9029
9030 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9031 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9032 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9033
9034 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9035
9036 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9037
9038 Examples:
9039 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9040 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9041 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9042 option tcp-check
9043 tcp-check connect
9044 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9045 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9046 tcp-check send \r\n
9047 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9048 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9049 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9050 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9051 tcp-check send \r\n
9052 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9053 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9054
9055 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9056 option tcp-check
9057 tcp-check connect port 110
9058 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9059 tcp-check connect port 143
9060 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9061 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9062
9063 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9064
9065
9066tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009067 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009068 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9069 no | no | yes | yes
9070
9071 Arguments :
9072 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9073 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9074 binary.
9075 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9076 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9077 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9078
9079 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9080 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9081 with the usual backslash ('\').
9082 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009083 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009084 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9085 used upper or lower case.
9086
9087
9088 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9089
9090 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9091 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9092 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9093 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9094 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9095 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9096 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9097 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9098
9099 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9100 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9101 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9102 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9103 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9104 expression.
9105
9106 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9107 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9108 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9109 this exact hexadecimal string.
9110 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9111
9112 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9113 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9114 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9115 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9116 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9117 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9118 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9119 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9120 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9121 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9122 the null character.
9123
9124 Examples :
9125 # perform a POP check
9126 option tcp-check
9127 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9128
9129 # perform an IMAP check
9130 option tcp-check
9131 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9132
9133 # look for the redis master server
9134 option tcp-check
9135 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009136 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009137 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9138 tcp-check expect string role:master
9139 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9140 tcp-check expect string +OK
9141
9142
9143 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9144 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9145
9146
9147tcp-check send <data>
9148 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9150 no | no | yes | yes
9151
9152 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9153 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9154
9155 Examples :
9156 # look for the redis master server
9157 option tcp-check
9158 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9159 tcp-check expect string role:master
9160
9161 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9162 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9163
9164
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009165tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9166 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009167 tcp health check
9168 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9169 no | no | yes | yes
9170
9171 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9172 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009174 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9175 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9176 hexadecimal string.
9177 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9178
9179 Examples :
9180 # redis check in binary
9181 option tcp-check
9182 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9183 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9184
9185
9186 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9187 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9188
9189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009190tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9191 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9193 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009194 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009195 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9196 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009198 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009199
9200 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9201 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009202 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9203 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9204 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9205 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9206 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9207 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009209 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9210 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9211 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9212 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009213
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009214 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009215 - accept :
9216 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9217 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9218 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009220 - reject :
9221 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9222 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9223 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9224 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9225 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9226 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9227 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9228 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9229 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9230 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9231 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009232 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009233
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009234 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9235 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9236 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9237 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9238 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9239 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9240 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9241 hosts.
9242
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009243 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9244 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9245 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9246 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9247 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9248 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9249 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9250 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9251
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009252 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9253 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9254 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9255 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9256 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9257 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9258 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9259 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9260 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009261 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9262 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009263
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009264 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009265 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009266 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9267 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9268 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9269 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9270 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9271 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9272 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9273 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9274 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9275 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9276 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9277 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009279 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009280 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009281 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009282 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009283 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9284 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9285 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009287 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9288 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9289 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9290 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009292 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9293 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9294 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9295 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9296 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009297 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9298 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9299 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9300 layer7 information is extracted.
9301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009302 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9303 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9304 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9305 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9306 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009307
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009308 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9309 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9310 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9311 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9312
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009313 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9314 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9315 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9316 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9317
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009318 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9319 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9320 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9321 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9322 continues.
9323
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009324 - set-src <expr> :
9325 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9326 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9327 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9328 set-src"
9329
9330 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9331 followed by some converters.
9332
9333 Example:
9334
9335 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9336
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009337 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9338 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009339
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009340 - set-src-port <expr> :
9341 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9342 expression.
9343
9344 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9345 followed by some converters.
9346
9347 Example:
9348
9349 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9350
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009351 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9352 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9353 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009354
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009355 - set-dst <expr> :
9356 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9357 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9358 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9359 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9360 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9361
9362 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9363 followed by some converters.
9364
9365 Example:
9366
9367 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9368 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9369
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009370 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9371 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9372
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009373 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9374 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9375 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9376 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9377
9378
9379 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9380 followed by some converters.
9381
9382 Example:
9383
9384 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9385
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009386 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9387 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9388 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9389
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009390 - "silent-drop" :
9391 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009392 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009393 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9394 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9395 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9396 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9397 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009398 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9399 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009400 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9401 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009402 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009403 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9404 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9405 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9406 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009408 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9409 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9410 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009411
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009412 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9413 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9414 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009415
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009416 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009417 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009418 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009420 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9421 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9422 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009423
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009424 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009425 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9426 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009427
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009428 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9429
9430 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9431
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009432 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9433
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009434 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009435
9436
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009437tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9438 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009440 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009441 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009442 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9443 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009444
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009445 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009447 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009448 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9449 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9450 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9451 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009453 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9454 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9455 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9456 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009457 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9458 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9459 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9460 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9461 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9462 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009463 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009464 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009465
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009466 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9467 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9468 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9469 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009470
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009471 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009472 - accept : the request is accepted
9473 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9474 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009475 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009476 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009477 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009478 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009479 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009480 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009481 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009482 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009483 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009484
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009485 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9486 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009487
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009488 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9489 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9490 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9491 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9492 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9493 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009495 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009496 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9497 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009499 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009500 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9501 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9502 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9503 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009504 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9505 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9506 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009507
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009508 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009509 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9510 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9511 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009512
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009513 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009514 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9515 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009516
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009517 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9518 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009519 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009520 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9521 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009522 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009523 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009524 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009525 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9526 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009527 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009528 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9529 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009530
9531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9532 followed by some converters.
9533
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009534 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9535 <var-name>.
9536
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009537 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9538 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9539 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9540 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9541 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9542
9543 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9544 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9545 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9546 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9547 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9548 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9549 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9550 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9551 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9552 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9553 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9554
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009555 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9556 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9557 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9558 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9559 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9560
9561 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9562
9563 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9564
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009565 Example:
9566
9567 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009568 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009569
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009570 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009571 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9572 # and reject everything else.
9573 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9574 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009575 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009576 tcp-request content reject
9577
9578 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009579 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9580 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9581 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009582 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009583
9584 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9585 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9586 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009587 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009588 tcp-request content reject
9589
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009590 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009591 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009592 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009593 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009594 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9595 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009596
9597 Example:
9598 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9599 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009600 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009602 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009603 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009604
9605 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009607 # protecting all our sites
9608 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009609 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9610 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009611 ...
9612 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9613
9614 backend http_dynamic
9615 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009616 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009617 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009618 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009619 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009620 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009621 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009623 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009624
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009625 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9626 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009627
9628
9629tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9630 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009632 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009633 Arguments :
9634 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9635 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9636 as explained at the top of this document.
9637
9638 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9639 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9640 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9641 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9642 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9643
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009644 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9645 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9646 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9647 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9648
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009649 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9650 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009651 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009652 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009653 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9654 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9655 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9656 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009657
9658 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9659 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9660 it pass through unaffected.
9661
9662 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9663 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9664 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009665 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009666 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9667 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009668 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9669 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9670 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009671
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009672 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009673 "timeout client".
9674
9675
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009676tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9677 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9679 no | no | yes | yes
9680 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009681 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9682 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009683
9684 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9685
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009686 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009687 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9688 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009689 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9690 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009691
9692 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9693
9694 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9695 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9696 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9697 inserted.
9698
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009699 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009700 - accept :
9701 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9702 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9703 the rules evaluation.
9704
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009705 - close :
9706 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9707 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9708 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9709 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9710 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9711 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009712 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009713 protocols.
9714
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009715 - reject :
9716 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9717 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009718 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009719
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009720 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9721 Sets a variable.
9722
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009723 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9724 Unsets a variable.
9725
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009726 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9727 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9728 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9729 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9730
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009731 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9732 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9733 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9734 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9735
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009736 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9737 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9738 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9739 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9740 continues.
9741
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009742 - "silent-drop" :
9743 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009744 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009745 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9746 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9747 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9748 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9749 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009750 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9751 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009752 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9753 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009754 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009755 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9756 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9757 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9758 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9759
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009760 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9761 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9762
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009763 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9764 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9765 for changing the default action to a reject.
9766
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009767 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9768 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9769 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9770 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009771 period.
9772
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009773 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9774 declared inline.
9775
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009776 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9777 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009778 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009779 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9780 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009781 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009782 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009783 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009784 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9785 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009786 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009787 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9788 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009789
9790 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9791 followed by some converters.
9792
9793 Example:
9794
9795 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9796
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009797 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9798 <var-name>.
9799
9800 Example:
9801
9802 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9803
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009804 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9805 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9806 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9807 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9808 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9809
9810 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9811
9812 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9813
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009814 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9815
9816 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9817
9818
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009819tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9820 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9822 no | yes | yes | no
9823 Arguments :
9824 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9825 below.
9826
9827 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9828
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009829 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009830 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9831 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9832 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9833 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9834 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9835 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9836 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009837 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009838 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9839 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9840 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9841 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9842 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9843 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9844 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9845 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9846 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9847 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9848 instead.
9849
9850 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9851 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9852 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9853 rules which may be inserted.
9854
9855 Several types of actions are supported :
9856 - accept : the request is accepted
9857 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9858 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9859 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009860 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009861 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9862 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009863 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009864 - silent-drop
9865
9866 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9867 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9868 sections for a complete description.
9869
9870 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9871 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9872 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9873
9874 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9875 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9876 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9877 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9878 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9879
9880 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9881 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9882
9883 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9884 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9885 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9886
9887 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9888 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9889 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9890
9891 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9892 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9893 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9894
9895 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9896 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9897 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9898
9899 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9900
9901 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9902
9903
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009904tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9905 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9907 no | no | yes | yes
9908 Arguments :
9909 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9910 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9911 as explained at the top of this document.
9912
9913 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9914
9915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009916timeout check <timeout>
9917 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9918 established.
9919
9920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9921 yes | no | yes | yes
9922 Arguments:
9923 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9924 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9925 as explained at the top of this document.
9926
9927 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9928 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009929 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009930 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009931 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9932 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9933 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009934
9935 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9936 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9937
9938 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9939 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009940 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009941
9942 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9943 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9944 forget about it.
9945
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009946 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9947 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009948
9949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009950timeout client <timeout>
9951timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9952 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9954 yes | yes | yes | no
9955 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009956 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009957 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9958 as explained at the top of this document.
9959
9960 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9961 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9962 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009963 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9964 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9965 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9966 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009967 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9968 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9969 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009970 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009971 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009972 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9973 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009974 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9975 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009976
9977 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9978 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9979 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9980 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9981 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9982 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9983
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009984 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009986 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9987 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9988 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9989
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009990 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9991 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009992
9993
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009994timeout client-fin <timeout>
9995 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9997 yes | yes | yes | no
9998 Arguments :
9999 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10000 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10001 as explained at the top of this document.
10002
10003 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10004 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10005 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10006 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10007 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10008 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10009 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010010 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10011 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10012 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010013
10014 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10015 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10016 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10017
10018 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10019
10020
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010021timeout connect <timeout>
10022timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10023 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10025 yes | no | yes | yes
10026 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010027 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010028 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10029 as explained at the top of this document.
10030
10031 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010032 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010033 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010034 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010035 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10036 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010037
10038 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10039 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10040 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10041 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10042 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10043 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10044
10045 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10046 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10047 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10048
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010049 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10050 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010051
10052
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010053timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10054 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10056 yes | yes | yes | yes
10057 Arguments :
10058 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10059 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10060 as explained at the top of this document.
10061
10062 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10063 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10064 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10065 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10066 once the request has started to present itself.
10067
10068 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10069 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10070 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10071 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10072 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10073
10074 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10075 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10076 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10077 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10078
10079 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10080 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010081 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010082 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10083 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010084 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010085
10086 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10087 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10088 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10089 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10090
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010091 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10092 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010093 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10094
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010095 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10096
10097
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010098timeout http-request <timeout>
10099 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010101 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010102 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010103 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010104 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10105 as explained at the top of this document.
10106
10107 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10108 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10109 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10110 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10111 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10112 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10113 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010114 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10115 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10116 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10117 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010118 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010119 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10120 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010121
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010122 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10123 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10124 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10125 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10126 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010127 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010128
10129 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10130 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010131 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010132 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10133 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10134
10135 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010136 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10137 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10138 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010139
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010140 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010141 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010142
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010143
10144timeout queue <timeout>
10145 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10147 yes | no | yes | yes
10148 Arguments :
10149 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10150 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10151 as explained at the top of this document.
10152
10153 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10154 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10155 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10156 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10157 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10158
10159 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10160 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10161 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10162 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10163
10164 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10165
10166
10167timeout server <timeout>
10168timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10169 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10171 yes | no | yes | yes
10172 Arguments :
10173 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10174 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10175 as explained at the top of this document.
10176
10177 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10178 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10179 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10180 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10181 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10182 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10183 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10184
10185 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10186 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10187 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10188 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10189 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010190 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010191 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010192 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10193 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010194 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10195 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010196
10197 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10198 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10199 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10200 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10201 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10202 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10203
10204 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10205 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10206 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10207
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010208 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010209
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010210
10211timeout server-fin <timeout>
10212 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10214 yes | no | yes | yes
10215 Arguments :
10216 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10217 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10218 as explained at the top of this document.
10219
10220 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10221 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10222 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10223 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10224 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10225 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10226 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10227 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10228 situations, it should not be needed.
10229
10230 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10231 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10232 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10233
10234 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10235
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010236
10237timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010238 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10240 yes | yes | yes | yes
10241 Arguments :
10242 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10243 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10244 as explained at the top of this document.
10245
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010246 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10247 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10248 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10249 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010250
10251 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10252 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10253 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10254 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010255 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010256
10257 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10258
10259
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010260timeout tunnel <timeout>
10261 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10263 yes | no | yes | yes
10264 Arguments :
10265 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10266 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10267 as explained at the top of this document.
10268
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010269 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010270 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10271 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10272 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010273 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10274 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010275 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10276 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10277 specified.
10278
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010279 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10280 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10281 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10282 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10283 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10284 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10285 state.
10286
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010287 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10288 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10289 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10290 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010291 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010292
10293 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10294 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10295 forget about it.
10296
10297 Example :
10298 defaults http
10299 option http-server-close
10300 timeout connect 5s
10301 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010302 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010303 timeout server 30s
10304 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10305
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010306 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010307
10308
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010309transparent (deprecated)
10310 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010312 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010313 Arguments : none
10314
10315 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10316 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10317 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10318 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10319 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10320 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10321 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10322 appropriate server.
10323
10324 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10325
10326 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10327 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10328
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010329 See also: "option transparent"
10330
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010331unique-id-format <string>
10332 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10334 yes | yes | yes | no
10335 Arguments :
10336 <string> is a log-format string.
10337
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010338 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10339 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10340 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10341 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010342
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010343 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10344 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10345 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10346 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10347 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10348 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10349 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10350 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010351
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010352 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10353 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010354
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010355 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010356
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010357 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010358
10359 will generate:
10360
10361 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10362
10363 See also: "unique-id-header"
10364
10365unique-id-header <name>
10366 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10368 yes | yes | yes | no
10369 Arguments :
10370 <name> is the name of the header.
10371
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010372 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10373 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010374
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010375 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010376
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010377 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010378 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10379
10380 will generate:
10381
10382 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10383
10384 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010385
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010386use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010387 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10389 no | yes | yes | no
10390 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010391 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10392 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010393
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010394 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10395 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010396
10397 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10398 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10399 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010400 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010401 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010402 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10403 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010404
10405 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10406 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10407 assign the backend.
10408
10409 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10410 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10411 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10412 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10413 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10414 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10415
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010416 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010417 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010418 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10419 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10420 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10421
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010422 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10423 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10424 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10425 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10426 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10427 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10428 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10429 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10430 cannot be forced from the request.
10431
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010432 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010433 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10434 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10435
10436 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10437 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010438
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010439
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010440use-server <server> if <condition>
10441use-server <server> unless <condition>
10442 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10444 no | no | yes | yes
10445 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010446 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010447
10448 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10449
10450 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10451 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10452 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10453
10454 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10455 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10456 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10457 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10458 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10459 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10460 matches will assign the server.
10461
10462 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10463 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10464 with the next rules until one matches.
10465
10466 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10467 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10468 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10469 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10470
10471 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10472 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10473 stripped.
10474
10475 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10476 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10477 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10478 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10479
10480 Example :
10481 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10482 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10483 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10484 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10485 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10486 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010487 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010488 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10489 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10490
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010491 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010492
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010493
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100104945. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010495--------------------------
10496
10497The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10498depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10499settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10500written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10501described in this section.
10502
10503
105045.1. Bind options
10505-----------------
10506
10507The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10508as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10509no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10510parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10511while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10512provided immediately after the setting name.
10513
10514The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10515
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010516accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10517 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10518 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10519 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10520 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10521 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10522 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10523 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10524 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10525 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010526 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10527 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10528 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010530accept-proxy
10531 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010532 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10533 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010534 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10535 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10536 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10537 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010538 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010539 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10540 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010541 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10542 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010543
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010544allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010545 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010546 due to security considerations.
10547
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010548alpn <protocols>
10549 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10550 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10551 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10552 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10553 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010554 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10555 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10556 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10557 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10558 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10559 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10560 preference, like below :
10561
10562 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010563
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010564backlog <backlog>
10565 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10566 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10567
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010568curves <curves>
10569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10570 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10571 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10572 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10573 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10574 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10575
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010576ecdhe <named curve>
10577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010578 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10579 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010580
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010581ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10583 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10584 client's certificate.
10585
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010586ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10587 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10588 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10589 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10590 error is ignored.
10591
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010592ca-sign-file <cafile>
10593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10594 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10595 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10596 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10597 'generate-certificates' for details.
10598
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010599ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10601 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10602 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10603 'generate-certificates' for details.
10604
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010605ciphers <ciphers>
10606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10607 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010608 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10609 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10610 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10611 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10612 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10613 information and recommendations see e.g.
10614 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10615 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10616 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10617
10618ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10620 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10621 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10622 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10623 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10624 string such as
10625 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10626 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10627 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010628
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010629crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10631 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10632 to verify client's certificate.
10633
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010634crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10636 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10637 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10638 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10639 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10640 file.
10641
10642 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10643 are loaded.
10644
10645 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010646 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010647 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10648 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10649 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10650 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010651 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10652 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010653 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010654
10655 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10656 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10657 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10658 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010659 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10660 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010661
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010662 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010663
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010664 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010665 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010666 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10667 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010668 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10669 clients).
10670
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010671 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10672 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10673 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10674 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10675 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10676 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10677 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10678 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10679 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10680 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10681 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10682 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10683 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10684
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010685 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10686 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10687 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10688 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10689 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10690
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010691 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10692 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10693 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10694 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010695
10696 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10697 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10698 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10699 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10700 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10701 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10702 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10703 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10704 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10705
10706 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10707
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010708 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010709 a cert bundle.
10710
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010711 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010712 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10713 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10714 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10715 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10716 provide multi-cert support.
10717
10718 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10719
10720 Filename | CN | SAN
10721 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10722 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010723 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010724 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10725 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10726
10727 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10728 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10729 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10730 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010731 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10732 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10733 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010734
10735 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10736 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10737
10738 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10739 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10740 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10741
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010742crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010745 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010746 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010747
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010748crt-list <file>
10749 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010750 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10751 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010752
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010753 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10754
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010755 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10756 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010757 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010758 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010759
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010760 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10761 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10762 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10763 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10764 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10765 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10766 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10767 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010768
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010769 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010770 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010771 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10772 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10773 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010774
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010775 crt-list file example:
10776 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010777 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010778 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010779 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010780
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010781defer-accept
10782 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10783 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10784 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010786 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10787 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10788 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10789 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10790 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10791 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10792 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10793
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010794expose-fd listeners
10795 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10796 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010797 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10798 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010799 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010800
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010801force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010802 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010803 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010804 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010805 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010806
10807force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010808 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010809 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010810 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010811
10812force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010813 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010814 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010815 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010816
10817force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010818 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010819 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010820 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010821
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010822force-tlsv13
10823 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10824 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010825 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010826
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010827generate-certificates
10828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10829 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10830 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10831 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10832 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10833 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10834 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10835 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10836 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10837 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10838 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10839
10840 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10841 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010842 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010843 certificate is used many times.
10844
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010845gid <gid>
10846 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10847 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10848 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10849 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10850 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10851
10852group <group>
10853 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10854 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10855 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10856 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10857 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10858
10859id <id>
10860 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10861 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10862 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10863 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10864
10865interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010866 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10867 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10868 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10869 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10870 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10871 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010872 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10873 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10874 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10875 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10876 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10877 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010878
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010879level <level>
10880 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10881 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10882 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010883 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010884 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10885 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10886 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010887 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010888 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010889 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010890 all counters).
10891
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010892severity-output <format>
10893 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10894 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10895 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10896 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10897 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10898 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10899 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10900 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10901 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10902 rfc5424 convention.
10903
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010904maxconn <maxconn>
10905 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10906 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10907 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10908 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10909 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10910 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10911 eat all memory.
10912
10913mode <mode>
10914 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10915 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10916 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10917 UNIX sockets.
10918
10919mss <maxseg>
10920 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10921 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10922 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10923 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10924 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10925 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10926 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10927 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10928 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10929 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10930 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10931
10932name <name>
10933 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10934 page.
10935
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010936namespace <name>
10937 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10938 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10939 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10940 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10941
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010942nice <nice>
10943 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10944 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10945 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10946 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10947 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10948 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10949 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10950 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10951 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10952 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10953 one for an RDP socket.
10954
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010955no-ca-names
10956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10957 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10958
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010959no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010960 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010961 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010962 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010963 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010964 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10965 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010966
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010967no-tls-tickets
10968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10969 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10970 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010971 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10972 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010973
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010974no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010976 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010977 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010978 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010979 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10980 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010982no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010984 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010985 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010986 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010987 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10988 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010989
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010990no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010992 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010993 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010994 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010995 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10996 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010997
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010998no-tlsv13
10999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11000 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11001 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11002 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011003 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11004 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011005
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011006npn <protocols>
11007 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11008 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11009 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11010 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011011 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011012 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11013 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11014 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11015 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11016 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011017
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011018prefer-client-ciphers
11019 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11020 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11021 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011022 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11023 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11024 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011025
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011026process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11027 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11028 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011030 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11031 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11032 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11033 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011034 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011035 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11036 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11037 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11038
11039 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11040
11041 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11042 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11043 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11044 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11045 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11046 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11047 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11048 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011049
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011050proto <name>
11051 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11052 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11053 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11054 in haproxy -vv.
11055 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11056 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
11057 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifing "proto
11058 h2" on the bind line.
11059
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011060ssl
11061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011062 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011063 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11064 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011065 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11066 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011067
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011068ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11069 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11070 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11071 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11072
11073ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11074 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11075 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11076 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11077
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011078strict-sni
11079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11080 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11081 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11082 See the "crt" option for more information.
11083
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011084tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011085 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011086 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11087 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011088 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011089 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11090 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11091 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11092 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11093 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11094 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11095 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11096
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011097tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011098 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011099 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11100 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11101 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11102 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11103 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11104 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11105 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011106 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11107 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11108 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011109
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011110tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11111 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11112 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11113 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11114 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11115 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11116 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11117 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11118 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11119 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11120 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11121
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011122transparent
11123 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11124 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11125 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11126 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11127 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11128 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11129 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11130 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11131 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11132 so check for support with your vendor.
11133
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011134v4v6
11135 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11136 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11137 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11138 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011139 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011140
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011141v6only
11142 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11143 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11144 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011145 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11146 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011148uid <uid>
11149 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11150 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11151 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11152 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11153 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11154
11155user <user>
11156 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11157 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11158 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11159 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11160 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11161
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011162verify [none|optional|required]
11163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11164 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11165 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11166 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11167 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011168 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11169 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11170 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11171 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011172
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200111735.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011174------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011176The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11177which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11178arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11179settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11180after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11181Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11182address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011184 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011185 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011186
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011187Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11188keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011190The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011191
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011192addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011193 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011194 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11195 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11196 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11197 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11198 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011199
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011200agent-check
11201 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011202 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11203 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11204 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11205 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011206
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011207 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011208 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011209 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11210 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11211 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011212
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011213 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11214 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11215 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11216 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11217 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011218
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011219 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011220 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011221
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011222 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11223 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11224 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011225
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011226 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11227 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11228 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011229
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011230 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11231 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11232 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11233 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11234 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011235 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011236 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011237
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011238 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11239 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011240
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011241 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11242 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11243 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11244 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11245 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11246 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11247 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11248 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11249 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011250
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011251 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11252 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011253 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11254 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11255 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011256 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011257
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011258 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011259 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011260
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011261agent-send <string>
11262 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11263 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11264 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11265 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11266 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11267
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011268agent-inter <delay>
11269 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11270 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11271
11272 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11273 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11274 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11275 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11276 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11277 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11278 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11279 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11280 of backends use the same servers.
11281
11282 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11283
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011284agent-addr <addr>
11285 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11286
11287 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11288 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11289 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11290 hostname, it will be resolved.
11291
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011292agent-port <port>
11293 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11294
11295 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011297backup
11298 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11299 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11300 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11301 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011302 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11303 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011304
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011305ca-file <cafile>
11306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11307 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11308 server's certificate.
11309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011310check
11311 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011312 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11313 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11314 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11315 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11316 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11317 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11318 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011319 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11320 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011321 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11322 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011323
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011324check-send-proxy
11325 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11326 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11327 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11328 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11329 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11330 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11331 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11332
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011333check-sni
11334 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11335 over SSL.
11336
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011337check-ssl
11338 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11339 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11340 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11341 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011342 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011343 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11344 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011345 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011346 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11347 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011348
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011349ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11351 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11352 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011353 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11354 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11355 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11356 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11357 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11358 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11359
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011360ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11362 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11363 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11364 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11365 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011367cookie <value>
11368 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11369 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11370 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11371 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11372 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11373 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11374 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11375
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011376crl-file <crlfile>
11377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11378 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11379 to verify server's certificate.
11380
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011381crt <cert>
11382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11383 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11384 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11385 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11386 certificate request.
11387
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011388disabled
11389 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11390 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11391 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11392 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11393 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011394 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011395
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011396enabled
11397 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11398 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11399 default value.
11400 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11401 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011403error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011404 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11405 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11406 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011408 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011410fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011411 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11412 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11413 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11414
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011415force-sslv3
11416 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11417 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011418 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011419 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011420
11421force-tlsv10
11422 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011423 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011424 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011425
11426force-tlsv11
11427 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011428 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011429 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011430
11431force-tlsv12
11432 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011433 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011434 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011435
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011436force-tlsv13
11437 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11438 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011439 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011441id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011442 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11443 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11444 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011445
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011446init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11447 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11448 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011449 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011450 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11451 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11452 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11453 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11454 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11455 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11456 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11457 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11458 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011459 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011460 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11461 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11462 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11463 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11464 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11465 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011466 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011467
11468 Example:
11469 defaults
11470 # never fail on address resolution
11471 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011473inter <delay>
11474fastinter <delay>
11475downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011476 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11477 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11478 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11479 between checks depending on the server state :
11480
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011481 Server state | Interval used
11482 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11483 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11484 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11485 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11486 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11487 or yet unchecked. |
11488 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11489 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11490 | "inter" otherwise.
11491 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011493 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11494 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11495 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11496 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011497 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11498 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11499 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11500 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11501 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011503maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011504 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11505 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11506 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11507 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11508 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11509 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11510 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11511 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011513maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011514 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11515 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11516 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11517 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11518 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11519 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11520 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011522minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011523 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11524 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11525 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11526 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11527 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11528 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011529 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011530 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011531
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011532namespace <name>
11533 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11534 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11535 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11536 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11537
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011538no-agent-check
11539 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11540 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11541 default value.
11542 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11543 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11544
11545no-backup
11546 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11547 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11548 default value.
11549 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11550 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11551
11552no-check
11553 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11554 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11555 default value.
11556 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11557 "default-server" "check" setting.
11558
11559no-check-ssl
11560 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11561 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11562 default value.
11563 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11564 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11565
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011566no-send-proxy
11567 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11568 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11569 default value.
11570 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11571 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11572
11573no-send-proxy-v2
11574 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11575 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11576 default value.
11577 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11578 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11579
11580no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11581 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11582 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11583 default value.
11584 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11585 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11586
11587no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11588 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11589 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11590 default value.
11591 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11592 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11593
11594no-ssl
11595 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11596 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11597 default value.
11598 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11599 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11600
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011601no-ssl-reuse
11602 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11603 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11604 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11605 and for paranoid users.
11606
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011607no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011608 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11609 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011610 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011611
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011612 Supported in default-server: No
11613
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011614no-tls-tickets
11615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11616 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11617 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011618 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11619 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011620 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011621
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011622no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011623 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011624 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11625 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011626 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11627 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011628 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011629
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011630 Supported in default-server: No
11631
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011632no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011633 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011634 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11635 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011636 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11637 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011638 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011639
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011640 Supported in default-server: No
11641
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011642no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011643 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011644 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11645 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011646 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11647 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011648 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011649
11650 Supported in default-server: No
11651
11652no-tlsv13
11653 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11654 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11655 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11656 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11657 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011658 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011659
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011660 Supported in default-server: No
11661
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011662no-verifyhost
11663 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11664 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11665 default value.
11666 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11667 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011668
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011669non-stick
11670 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11671 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11672 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011674observe <mode>
11675 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11676 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11677 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11678 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11679 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11680 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011681 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011682
11683 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011685on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011686 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11687 Currently, four modes are available:
11688 - fastinter: force fastinter
11689 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11690 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11691 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11692 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11693
11694 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11695
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011696on-marked-down <action>
11697 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11698 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011699 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11700 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11701 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11702 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11703 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11704 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11705 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11706 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011707
11708 Actions are disabled by default
11709
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011710on-marked-up <action>
11711 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11712 Currently one action is available:
11713 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11714 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11715 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11716 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011717 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11718 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011719 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11720 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11721
11722 Actions are disabled by default
11723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011724port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011725 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11726 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11727 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11728 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11729 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11730 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11731
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011732proto <name>
11733
11734 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11735 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11736 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11737 reported in haproxy -vv.
11738 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11739 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011741redir <prefix>
11742 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11743 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11744 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11745 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11746 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11747 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11748 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11749 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011750 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011751 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011752 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11753 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11754 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11755 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11756
11757 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011759rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011760 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11761 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11762 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11763
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011764resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11765 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11766 server.
11767
11768 Available options:
11769
11770 * allow-dup-ip
11771 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11772 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11773 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11774 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11775 For such case, simply enable this option.
11776 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11777
11778 * prevent-dup-ip
11779 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11780 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11781 same fqdn.
11782 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11783
11784 Example:
11785 backend b_myapp
11786 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11787 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11788 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11789
11790 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11791 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11792 it
11793 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11794 different address
11795
11796 Default value: not set
11797
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011798resolve-prefer <family>
11799 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11800 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11801 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11802 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11803
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011804 Default value: ipv6
11805
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011806 Example:
11807
11808 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011809
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011810resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11811 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11812 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011813 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011814 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11815 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011816 configured network, another address is selected.
11817
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011818 Example:
11819
11820 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011821
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011822resolvers <id>
11823 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11824 hostname.
11825
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011826 Example:
11827
11828 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011829
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011830 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011831
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011832send-proxy
11833 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11834 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11835 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11836 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011837 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11838 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11839 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11840 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11841 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11842 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11843 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11844 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11845 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11846 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011847 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11848 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011849
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011850send-proxy-v2
11851 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11852 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11853 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11854 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011855 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11856 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11857 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11858 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011859
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011860proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11861 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11862 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011863 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
11864 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010011865 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
11866 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010011867 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011868
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011869send-proxy-v2-ssl
11870 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11871 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11872 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11873 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11874 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11875 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11876 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011877 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11878 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011879
11880send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11881 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11882 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11883 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11884 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11885 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11886 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11887 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11888 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011889 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
11890 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011892slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011893 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11894 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11895 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11896 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11897 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11898 parameters :
11899
11900 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11901 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11902
11903 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11904 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11905 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11906 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11907
11908 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11909 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11910 seen as failed.
11911
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011912sni <expression>
11913 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11914 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11915 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11916 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011917 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11918 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011919 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11920 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011921
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011922source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011923source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011924source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011925 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11926 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11927 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11928 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11929
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011930 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11931 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11932 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11933 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11934 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11935 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11936 server.
11937
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011938 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11939 specifying the source address without port(s).
11940
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011941ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011942 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11943 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11944 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11945 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11946 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11947 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011948 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11949 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011950
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011951ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11952 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11953 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11954 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11955
11956ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11957 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11958 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11959 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11960
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011961ssl-reuse
11962 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11963 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11964 default value.
11965 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11966 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11967
11968stick
11969 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11970 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11971 default value.
11972 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11973 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011974
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011975tcp-ut <delay>
11976 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11977 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11978 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011979 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011980 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11981 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11982 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11983 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11984 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11985 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11986 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11987 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11988 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011990track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011991 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11992 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11993 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11994 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011995 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11996
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011997tls-tickets
11998 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11999 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12000 default value.
12001 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12002 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012003
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012004verify [none|required]
12005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012006 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012007 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12008 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012009 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012010 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12011 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12012 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12013 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12014 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12015 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12016 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12017 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012018
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012019verifyhost <hostname>
12020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012021 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12022 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12023 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12024 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12025 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12026 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12027 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12028 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012030weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012031 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12032 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12033 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012034 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12035 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12036 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12037 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12038 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12039 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012040
12041
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120425.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12043-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012044
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012045HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12046using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12047configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012048This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12049can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12050workload.
12051This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12052resolution at run time.
12053Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12054carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12055
12056
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120575.3.1. Global overview
12058----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012059
12060As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12061different steps of the process life:
12062
12063 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12064 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12065 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012067 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12068 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012069
12070A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12071 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12072 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12073 resolution to know this new IP.
12074
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012075When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012076HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012077SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12078from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12079will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12080will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012081
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012082A few things important to notice:
12083 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12084 first valid response.
12085
12086 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12087 servers return an error.
12088
12089
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120905.3.2. The resolvers section
12091----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012092
12093This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012094HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12095contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012096
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012097When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12098uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12099is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12100answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12101
12102When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012103used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012104
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012105 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12106 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12107 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012108
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012109 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12110 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012111
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012112 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12113 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12114 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012115
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012116For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12117following scenarios are possible:
12118
12119 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12120 ignored
12121
12122 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12123 applied
12124
12125 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12126 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12127
12128 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12129 retries the query with a new type
12130
12131 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12132 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012133
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012134As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12135a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012136<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012137
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012138
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012139resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012140 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012141
12142A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12143
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012144accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012145 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012146 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012147 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12148 by RFC 6891)
12149
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012150 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12151
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012152nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12153 DNS server description:
12154 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12155 <ip> : IP address of the server
12156 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12157
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012158parse-resolv-conf
12159 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12160 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12161 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12162
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012163hold <status> <period>
12164 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12165 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012166 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012167 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012168 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12169 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12170 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12171
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012172 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012173
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012174resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012175 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12176 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12177 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12178
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012179resolve_retries <nb>
12180 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12181 giving up.
12182 Default value: 3
12183
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012184 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12185 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12186 type.
12187
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012188timeout <event> <time>
12189 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12190 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12191 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012192 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12193 other time applied.
12194 Default value: 1s
12195 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12196 have been received.
12197 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012198 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12199 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12200
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012201 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012202
12203 resolvers mydns
12204 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12205 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012206 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012207 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012208 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012209 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012210 hold other 30s
12211 hold refused 30s
12212 hold nx 30s
12213 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012214 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012215 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012216
12217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122186. HTTP header manipulation
12219---------------------------
12220
12221In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12222response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12223request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12224which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012225against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012227If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12228to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12229but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12230HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12231stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12232because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12233a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12234still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012236This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12237in section 4.2 :
12238
12239 - reqadd <string>
12240 - reqallow <search>
12241 - reqiallow <search>
12242 - reqdel <search>
12243 - reqidel <search>
12244 - reqdeny <search>
12245 - reqideny <search>
12246 - reqpass <search>
12247 - reqipass <search>
12248 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12249 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12250 - reqtarpit <search>
12251 - reqitarpit <search>
12252 - rspadd <string>
12253 - rspdel <search>
12254 - rspidel <search>
12255 - rspdeny <search>
12256 - rspideny <search>
12257 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12258 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12259
12260With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12261is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12262parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12263prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12264Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12265
12266 \t for a tab
12267 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12268 \n for a new line (LF)
12269 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12270 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12271 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12272 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12273 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12274
12275The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12276portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12277above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12278regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
122799 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12280is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12281
12282The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12283after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12284
12285Notes related to these keywords :
12286---------------------------------
12287 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12288 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12289 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12290
12291 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12292 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12293 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12294
12295 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12296 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12297 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12298 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12299 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12300
12301 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12302 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12303 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12304 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12305 useless headers before adding new ones.
12306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012307 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012308 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12309
12310 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12311 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12312 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12313
12314 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12315 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012316 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012317
12318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123197. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12320----------------------------------
12321
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012322HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012323client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12324The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12325these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12326but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12327data called patterns.
12328
12329
123307.1. ACL basics
12331---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012332
12333The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12334content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12335from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12336simple :
12337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012338 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012339 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012340 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12341 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012343The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12344adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012345
12346In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012348 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012349
12350This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12351Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12352and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012353an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12354conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12355as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12356are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012357
12358ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12359'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12360which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12361
12362There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12363performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12366specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12367this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012368methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12369ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012370
12371Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12372 - boolean
12373 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12374 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12375 - string
12376 - data block
12377
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012378Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12379converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12380would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12381The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12382which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12383
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012384Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12385keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12386fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12387which are summarized in the table below :
12388
12389 +---------------------+-----------------+
12390 | Sample or converter | Default |
12391 | output type | matching method |
12392 +---------------------+-----------------+
12393 | boolean | bool |
12394 +---------------------+-----------------+
12395 | integer | int |
12396 +---------------------+-----------------+
12397 | ip | ip |
12398 +---------------------+-----------------+
12399 | string | str |
12400 +---------------------+-----------------+
12401 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12402 +---------------------+-----------------+
12403
12404Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12405matching method, see below.
12406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012407The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12408 - boolean
12409 - integer or integer range
12410 - IP address / network
12411 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12412 - regular expression
12413 - hex block
12414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012415The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12416
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012417 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12418 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012419 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012420 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012421 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012422 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012423 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12426read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12427if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12428lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12429will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12430beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12431a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12432lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12433exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12434
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012435The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12436parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12437ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12438a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12439check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12440
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012441The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12442socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12443file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012445Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12446loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12447
12448 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12449
12450In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12451the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12452case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12453as well.
12454
12455The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12456sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12457do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12458methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12459is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012460obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12462default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12463that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12464string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12465
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012466The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12467By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12468string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12469resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12470server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12471waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12472flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12473function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012475There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12476sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12477be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012478
12479 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12480 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012481 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12482 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12483 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12484 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012485
12486 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12487 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012489
12490 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012491 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012492
12493 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012494 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012495
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012496 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012497 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12498
12499 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12500 binary or string samples.
12501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012502 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12503 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012505 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12506 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12507 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012509 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12510 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012512 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12513 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012515 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12516 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012518 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12519 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012520 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012522 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12523 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12524 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012525
12526For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12527request, it is possible to do :
12528
12529 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12530
12531In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12532buffer, one would use the following acl :
12533
12534 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12535
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012536On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12537possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12538
12539 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012541All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12542criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12543method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12544to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12545criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12546the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012549the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12550For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012552 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12553 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12554 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12555 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012556
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012557
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012558The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12559types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12560combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12561brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12562default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012564 +-------------------------------------------------+
12565 | Input sample type |
12566 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012567 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012568 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12569 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12570 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012571 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012572 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012573 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012574 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012575 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012576 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012577 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012578 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012579 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012580 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012581 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012583 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012584 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012585 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012587 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012588 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012589 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012590 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012591 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12593 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12594 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012595
12596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125977.1.1. Matching booleans
12598------------------------
12599
12600In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12601Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12602When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12603that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12604
12605Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12606return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12607"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126107.1.2. Matching integers
12611------------------------
12612
12613Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12614enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12615to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12616
12617Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12618matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12619lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012620
12621For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12622unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12623representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12624
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012625As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12626two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12627instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12628ranges and operators.
12629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012630For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012631operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12632Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12633of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012635Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012636
12637 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12638 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12639 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12640 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12641 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012643For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012644
12645 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12646
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012647This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12648
12649 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12650
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126527.1.3. Matching strings
12653-----------------------
12654
12655String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12656different forms :
12657
12658 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012659 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012660
12661 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012662 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012663
12664 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12665 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12666
12667 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12668 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12669
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012670 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012671 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12672 matches.
12673
12674 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12675 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12676 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012677
12678String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12679exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12680characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12681string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12682to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012683before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012684
12685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126867.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12687---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012688
12689Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12690they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12691possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12692passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12693the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012694the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12695match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012696
12697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126987.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12699-------------------------------------
12700
12701It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12702not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12703a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12704to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12705digits may be used upper or lower case.
12706
12707Example :
12708 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12709 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12710
12711
127127.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12713---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012714
12715IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12716netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12717within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012718host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012719difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12720at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12721does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12722parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012723
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012724The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12725abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12726
12727 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12728 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12729 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12730 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12731 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12732 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12733 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12734 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12735
12736Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12737192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12738
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012739IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12740Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12741trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12742IPv6 patterns.
12743
12744HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12745following situations :
12746 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12747 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12748 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12749 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12750 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12751 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12752 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12753 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12754 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12755 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012757
127587.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12759----------------------------------
12760
12761Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12762combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12763
12764 - AND (implicit)
12765 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12766 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012772Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12773indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012775For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12776"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12777requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12778is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12779
12780 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012781 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12782 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12783 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012784
12785To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12786and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12787
12788 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12789 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12790 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12791 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12792
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012793 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12795 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12796 use_backend www if host_www
12797
12798It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12799expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12800be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12801the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12802
12803 The following rule :
12804
12805 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012806 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012807
12808 Can also be written that way :
12809
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012810 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811
12812It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12813to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12814simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12815sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12816good use is the following :
12817
12818 With named ACLs :
12819
12820 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12821 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12822 monitor fail if site_dead
12823
12824 With anonymous ACLs :
12825
12826 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12827
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012828See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12829keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830
12831
128327.3. Fetching samples
12833---------------------
12834
12835Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12836against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12837sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12838ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12839of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12840available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12841
12842This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12843Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12844compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12845deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12846
12847The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12848matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12849method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12850indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12851
12852As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12853when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12854mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12855the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12856ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12857
12858Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12859multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12860when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012861incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12862are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12864all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12865
12866Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12867 - name
12868 - name(arg1)
12869 - name(arg1,arg2)
12870
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012871
128727.3.1. Converters
12873-----------------
12874
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012875Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12876of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12877is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12878was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012879has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012880unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12881
12882These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12883sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12884the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012885support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012886
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012887A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12888support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12889supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12890(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12891bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012894
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001289551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12896 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12897 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12898 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12899 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12900 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12901
12902 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012903 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
12904 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000012905 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12906 frontend http-in
12907 bind *:8081
12908 default_backend servers
12909 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12910 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12911
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012912add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012913 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012914 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012915 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12916 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012917 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012918 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12919 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12920 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12921 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012922 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012923 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012924
12925and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012926 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012927 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012928 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12929 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012930 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012931 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12932 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12933 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12934 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012936 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012937
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012938b64dec
12939 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12940 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12941
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012942base64
12943 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012944 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012945 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12946
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012947bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012948 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012949 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012950 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012951 presence of a flag).
12952
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012953bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12954 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12955 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012956 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012957
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010012958concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
12959 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
12960 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
12961 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
12962 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
12963 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
12964 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
12965 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
12966 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
12967 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
12968 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
12969 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
12970 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
12971 delimitors.
12972
12973 Example:
12974 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
12975 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
12976 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
12977 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
12978
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012979cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012980 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12981 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012982
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012983crc32([<avalanche>])
12984 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12985 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12986 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12987 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12988 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12989 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12990 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12991 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12992 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12993 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010012994 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
12995
12996crc32c([<avalanche>])
12997 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
12998 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12999 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13000 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13001 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13002 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13003 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13004 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013005
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013006da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013007 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13008 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13009 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13010 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013011 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013012 configuration language.
13013
13014 Example:
13015 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013016 bind *:8881
13017 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013018 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013019
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013020debug
13021 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13022 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13023 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13024
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013025div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013026 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13027 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013028 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013029 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13030 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013031 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013032 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13033 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13034 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13035 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013036 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013037 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013038
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013039djb2([<avalanche>])
13040 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13041 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13042 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13043 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13044 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13045 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13046 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013047 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13048 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013049
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013050even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013051 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013052 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13053
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013054field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13055 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13056 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13057 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13058 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13059 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13060 fields.
13061
13062 Example :
13063 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13064 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13065 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13066 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13067 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013068
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013069hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013070 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013071 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013072 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013073 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013074
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013075hex2i
13076 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13077 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13078
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013079http_date([<offset>])
13080 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13081 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13082 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13083 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13084 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13085 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013087in_table(<table>)
13088 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13089 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13090 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013091 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013092 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13093
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013094ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13095 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013096 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013097 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13098 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13099 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13100 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13101 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013102
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013103json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013104 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013105 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013106 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013107 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13108 of errors:
13109 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13110 bytes, ...)
13111 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13112 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13113
13114 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13115 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13116 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13117 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13118 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13119 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013120 - "ascii" : never fails;
13121 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13122 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013123 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013124 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013125 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13126 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13127
13128 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013129 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013130
13131 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013132 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013133 capture request header user-agent len 150
13134 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013135
13136 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13137 GET / HTTP/1.0
13138 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13139
13140 Output log:
13141 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13142
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013143language(<value>[,<default>])
13144 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13145 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13146 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13147 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13148 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13149 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13150 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13151 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13152 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013153 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013154 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13155 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013156
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013157 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013158
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013159 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13160 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013161
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013162 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13163 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13164 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13165 use_backend spanish if es
13166 use_backend french if fr
13167 use_backend english if en
13168 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013169
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013170length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013171 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13172 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13173 type. The result is of type integer.
13174
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013175lower
13176 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13177 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13178 type. The result is of type string.
13179
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013180ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13181 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13182 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13183 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13184 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13185 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13186 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13187
13188 Example :
13189
13190 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013191 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013192 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13193
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013194map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13195map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13196map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13197 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13198 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13199 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13200 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13201 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13202 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13203 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13204 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013205
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013206 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13207 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13208 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013209
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013210 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013211 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013213 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13214 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13215 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13216 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013217 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13218 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013219 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13220 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13221 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13222 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13223 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13224 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13225 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13226 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013227 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13228 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13229 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013230 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13231 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13232 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13233 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13234 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013235
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013236 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13237 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13238 the corresponding match text.
13239
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013240 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13241 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13242 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13243 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13244 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013245
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013246 Example :
13247
13248 # this is a comment and is ignored
13249 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13250 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13251 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13252 | | | `---------- value
13253 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13254 | `---------------------------- key
13255 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13256
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013257mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013258 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13259 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013260 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013261 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13265 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13266 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013267 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013268 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013269
13270mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013271 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013272 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13273 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013274 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013275 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013276 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013277 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13278 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13279 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13280 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013281 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013282 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013283
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013284nbsrv
13285 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13286 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13287 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13288 map lookup.
13289
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013290neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013291 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13292 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13293 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13294 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013295
13296not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013297 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013298 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013299 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013300 absence of a flag).
13301
13302odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013303 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013304 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13305
13306or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013307 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013308 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013309 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13310 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013311 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013312 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13313 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13314 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13315 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013317 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013318
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013319regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013320 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13321 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13322 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13323 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13324 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13325 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13326 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13327 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13328 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13329 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013330 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13331 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13332 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13333 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013334
13335 Example :
13336
13337 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13338 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13339 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13340 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13341
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013342capture-req(<id>)
13343 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13344 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13345
13346 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013347 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13348 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013349
13350capture-res(<id>)
13351 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13352 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13353
13354 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013355 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13356 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013357
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013358sdbm([<avalanche>])
13359 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13360 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13361 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13362 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13363 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13364 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13365 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013366 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13367 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013368
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013369set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013370 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13371 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13372 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013373 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013374 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13375 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013376 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013377 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13378 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013379 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013380 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013381
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013382sha1
13383 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13384 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13385
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013386strcmp(<var>)
13387 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13388 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13389 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13390 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13391 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13392 shorter).
13393
13394 Example :
13395
13396 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13397 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13398 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13399
13400
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013401sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013402 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13403 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013404 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013405 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13406 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013407 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013408 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13409 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013410 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013411 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13412 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013413 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013414 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013415
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013416table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13417 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13418 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13419 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13420 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13421 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13422 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13423
13424
13425table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13426 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13427 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13428 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13429 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13430 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13431 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13432
13433table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13434 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13435 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013436 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013437 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13438 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13439
13440table_conn_cur(<table>)
13441 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13442 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13443 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13444 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13445 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13446
13447table_conn_rate(<table>)
13448 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13449 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13450 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13451 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13452 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13453
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013454table_gpt0(<table>)
13455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13458 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13459 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13460
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013461table_gpc0(<table>)
13462 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13463 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13464 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13465 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13466 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13467
13468table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13469 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13470 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13471 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13472 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13473 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13474 sample fetch keyword.
13475
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013476table_gpc1(<table>)
13477 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13478 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13479 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13480 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13481 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13482
13483table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13484 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13485 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13486 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13487 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13488 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13489 sample fetch keyword.
13490
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013491table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013495 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13496 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13497
13498table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13499 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13500 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13501 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13502 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13503 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13504 keyword.
13505
13506table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13507 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13508 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013509 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013510 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13511 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13512
13513table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13514 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13515 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13516 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13517 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13518 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13519 keyword.
13520
13521table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13522 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13523 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013524 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013525 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13526 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13527 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13528 keyword.
13529
13530table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13531 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13532 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013534 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13535 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13536 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13537 keyword.
13538
13539table_server_id(<table>)
13540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13542 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13543 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13544 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13545 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13546
13547table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13548 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13549 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013550 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013551 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13552 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13553 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13554 keyword.
13555
13556table_sess_rate(<table>)
13557 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13558 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13559 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13560 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13561 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13562 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13563 keyword.
13564
13565table_trackers(<table>)
13566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13568 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13569 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13570 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13571 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13572 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13573 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13574 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13575 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13576
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013577upper
13578 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13579 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13580 type. The result is of type string.
13581
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013582url_dec
13583 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13584 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13585
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013586unset-var(<var name>)
13587 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13588 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13589 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13590 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13591 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13592 response),
13593 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13594 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13595 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13596 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13597
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013598utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13599 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13600 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13601 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13602 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13603 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13604 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13605
13606 Example :
13607
13608 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013609 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013610 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13611
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013612word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13613 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13614 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13615 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13616 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13617 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13618
13619 Example :
13620 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13621 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13622 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13623 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13624 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013625
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013626wt6([<avalanche>])
13627 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13628 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13629 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13630 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13631 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13632 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13633 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013634 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13635 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013636
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013637xor(<value>)
13638 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013639 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013640 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013641 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013642 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013643 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13644 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013645 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013646 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13647 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013648 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013649 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013650
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013651xxh32([<seed>])
13652 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13653 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13654 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13655 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13656 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13657 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13658 as cryptographically secure.
13659
13660xxh64([<seed>])
13661 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13662 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13663 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13664 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13665 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13666 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13667 as cryptographically secure.
13668
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013669
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136707.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671--------------------------------------------
13672
13673A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13674not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13675"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13676The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13677
13678always_false : boolean
13679 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13680 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13681
13682always_true : boolean
13683 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13684 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13685
13686avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013687 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013688 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13689 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13690 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13691 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13692 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13693 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13694 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13695 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13696 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13697 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13698 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13699 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13700 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013702be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013703 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13704 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13705 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13706 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013707 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13708
13709be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13710 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13711 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13712 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13713 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13714 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013715 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13716 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013717
13718 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13719 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13720 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013722be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13724 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13725 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013726 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013727 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13728 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013729
13730 Example :
13731 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13732 backend dynamic
13733 mode http
13734 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13735 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013736
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013737bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013738 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13739 of the string.
13740
13741bool(<bool>) : bool
13742 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13743 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13746 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013747 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013748 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13749 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013750
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013751 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013752 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013753 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13754
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013755 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13756 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013757
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013758 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013759 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013760 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013761 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013762 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013764 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013765
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013766 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13767 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013768 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013769 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013770
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013771date([<offset>]) : integer
13772 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13773 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13774 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13775 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013776 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13777
13778 Example :
13779
13780 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13781 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013782
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010013783date_us : integer
13784 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
13785 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
13786 from the same timeval structure.
13787
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013788distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13789 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13790 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13791 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13792 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13793 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13794 list of supported tokens.
13795
13796distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13797 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13798 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13799 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13800 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13801 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13802 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13803 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13804 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13805 supported tokens.
13806
13807 Example :
13808 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13809 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13810 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13811 # send large files to the big farm
13812 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13813
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013814env(<name>) : string
13815 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13816 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13817 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13818 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13819 certain way.
13820
13821 Examples :
13822 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13823 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13824
13825 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13826 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013828fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13829 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013830 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13831 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013832 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13833 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013834 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013835 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13836 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013837
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013838fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13839 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13840 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13841 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013843fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13844 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13845 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13846 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13847 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13848 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13849 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13850 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13851 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013852
13853 Example :
13854 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13855 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13856 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13857 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13858 frontend mail
13859 bind :25
13860 mode tcp
13861 maxconn 100
13862 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13863 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13864 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13865 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013866
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013867hostname : string
13868 Returns the system hostname.
13869
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013870int(<integer>) : signed integer
13871 Returns a signed integer.
13872
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013873ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13874 Returns an ipv4.
13875
13876ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13877 Returns an ipv6.
13878
13879meth(<method>) : method
13880 Returns a method.
13881
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013882nbproc : integer
13883 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13884 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13885 and debugging purposes.
13886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013887nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13888 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13889 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13890 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013891 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13892 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13893 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013894
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040013895prio_class : integer
13896 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
13897 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
13898 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
13899
13900prio_offset : integer
13901 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
13902 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
13903 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
13904 set-priority-offset".
13905
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013906proc : integer
13907 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13908 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13909 debugging purposes.
13910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013911queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013912 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13913 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13914 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013915 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13916 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13917 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13918 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13919 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13920
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013921rand([<range>]) : integer
13922 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13923 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13924 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13925 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13926 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013928srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13929 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13930 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13931 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13932 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13933 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013934 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
13935 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
13936
13937srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13939 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
13940 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13941 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
13942 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
13943 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
13944 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
13945
13946 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
13947 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013948
13949srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13950 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13951 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13952 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013953 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13955 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13956 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13957
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013958srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13959 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13960 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13961 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13962 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13963 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13964 fetch methods.
13965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013966srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13967 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13968 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013969 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13971 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013972 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013973 overloading servers).
13974
13975 Example :
13976 # Redirect to a separate back
13977 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13978 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13979 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13980
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013981stopping : boolean
13982 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13983 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13984 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13985
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013986str(<string>) : string
13987 Returns a string.
13988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13990 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13991 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13992
13993table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13994 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13995 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13996 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13997
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013998thread : integer
13999 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14000 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14001 and debugging purposes.
14002
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014003var(<var-name>) : undefined
14004 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014005 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14006 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14009 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014010 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014011 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14012 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014013 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014014 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140167.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014017----------------------------------
14018
14019The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14020closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14021methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14022sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14023TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014024the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14025counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014026"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14027used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14028can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14029Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14030table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14031tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14032currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014033
14034be_id : integer
14035 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14036 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14037
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014038be_name : string
14039 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14040 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014042dst : ip
14043 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14044 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14045 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14046 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14047 RFC 4291.
14048
14049dst_conn : integer
14050 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14051 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14052 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14053 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14054 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14055 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14056 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14057 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014058
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014059dst_is_local : boolean
14060 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14061 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14062 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14063 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014065 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14066 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14067 it only once per connection.
14068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014069dst_port : integer
14070 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14071 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14072 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14073 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14074 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14075 an HTTP header.
14076
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014077fc_http_major : integer
14078 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14079 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14080 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14081
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014082fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14083 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14084 header.
14085
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014086fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14087 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14088 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14089 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14090 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14091 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14092 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14093
14094fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14095 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14096 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14097 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14098 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14099 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14100 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14101
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014102fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14103 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14104 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14105 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14106 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14107
14108fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14109 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14110 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14111 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14112 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14113
14114fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14115 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14116 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14117 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14118 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14119
14120fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14121 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14122 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14123 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14124 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14125
14126fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14127 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14128 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14129 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14130 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14131
14132fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14133 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14134 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14135 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14136 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14137
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014138fe_defbe : string
14139 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14140 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014142fe_id : integer
14143 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014144 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14146
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014147fe_name : string
14148 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14149 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14150 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14151
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014152sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014153sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14154sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14155sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014156 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14157 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14158 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14159
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014160sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014161sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14162sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14163sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014164 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14165 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14166 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14167
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014168sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014169sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14170sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14171sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014172 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14173 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014174 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14175 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14176 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014177
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014178 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014179 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14180 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014181 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14182 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14183 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014184 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14185 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14186
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014187sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14188sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14189sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14190sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14191 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14192 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14193 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14194 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14195 when a first ACL was verified.
14196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014197sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014198sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14199sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14200sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014201 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014202 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14203
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014204sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014205sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14206sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14207sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014208 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14209 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14210 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14211
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014212sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014213sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14214sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14215sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014216 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14217 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14218 See also src_conn_rate.
14219
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014220sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014221sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14222sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14223sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014224 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014225 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014226
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014227sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14228sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14229sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14230sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14231 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14232 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14233
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014234sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14235sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14236sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14237sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14238 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14239 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14240
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014241sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014242sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14243sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14244sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014245 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14246 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14247 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014248 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14249 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14250 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014251
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014252sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14253sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14254sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14255sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14256 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14257 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14258 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14259 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14260 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14261 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14262
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014263sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014264sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14265sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14266sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014267 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014268 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14269 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14270
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014271sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014272sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14273sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14274sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014275 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14276 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14277 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14278 src_http_err_rate.
14279
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014280sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014281sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14282sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14283sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014284 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014285 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14286 src_http_req_cnt.
14287
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014288sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014289sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14290sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14291sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014292 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14293 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14294 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14295 src_http_req_rate.
14296
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014297sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014298sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14299sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14300sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014301 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014302 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14303 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14304 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14305 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014306
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014307 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014308 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14309 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014310 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14311
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014312sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14313sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14314sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14315sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14316 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14317 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14318 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14319 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14320 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14321
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014322sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014323sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14324sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14325sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014326 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14327 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14328 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014329
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014330sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014331sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14332sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14333sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014334 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14335 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14336 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014338sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014339sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14340sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14341sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014342 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014343 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14344 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14345 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014346 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014347 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14348
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014349sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014350sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14351sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14352sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014353 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14354 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14355 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14356 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14357 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014358 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014360sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014361sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14362sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14363sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014364 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14365 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14366 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014368sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014369sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14370sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14371sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014372 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14373 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014374 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014375 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14376 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14378 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14379 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381so_id : integer
14382 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14383 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14384 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014387 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014388 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14389 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14390 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014391 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14392 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14393 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14394 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014395
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014396 Example:
14397 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14398 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14401 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14402 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14403 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014404 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14407 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14408 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014409 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014410 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14413 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14414 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14415 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14416 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14417 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14418 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014419
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014420 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014421 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14422 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14423 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14424 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014425 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014426 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14427 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14428
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014429src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14430 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14431 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14432 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14433 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14434 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14435 was verified.
14436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014437src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014440 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014441 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014444 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014445 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14446 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014447 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014449src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14450 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14451 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14452 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014453 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014455src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014456 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014457 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014458 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014459 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014460
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014461src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14462 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14463 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14464 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14465 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14466
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014467src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14468 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14469 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14470 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14471 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014473src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014474 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014475 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014476 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14477 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014478 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14479 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14480 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014481
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014482src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14483 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14484 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14485 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14486 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14487 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14488 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14489 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014491src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014492 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014494 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014495 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14499 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14500 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14501 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14502 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014503 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014506 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014507 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14508 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014509 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014511src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14512 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14513 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14514 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014515 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014516 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014518src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14519 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14520 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14521 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014522 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014523 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14524 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014525
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014526 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014527 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014528 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014529 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014530
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014531src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14532 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14533 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14534 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14535 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14536 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14537 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14538
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014539src_is_local : boolean
14540 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14541 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14542 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14543 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014544 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014545 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14546 once per connection.
14547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014548src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014549 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14550 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14551 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14552 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14553 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014556 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14557 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14558 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14559 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14560 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562src_port : integer
14563 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14564 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14565 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14566 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014568src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014569 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014570 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14571 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14572 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014573 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14576 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14577 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14578 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14579 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014580 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014582src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14583 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14584 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14585 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14586 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14587 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14588 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14589 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14590 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014591
14592 Example :
14593 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14594 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14595 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14596 listen ssh
14597 bind :22
14598 mode tcp
14599 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014600 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014602 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014604srv_id : integer
14605 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14606 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14607 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014608
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146097.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014610----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014612The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14613closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14614when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14615usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014616future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014617
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001461851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14619 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14620 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14621 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14622 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14623 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14624
14625 Example :
14626 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14627 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14628 # the request.
14629 frontend http-in
14630 bind *:8081
14631 default_backend servers
14632 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14633 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14634
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014635ssl_bc : boolean
14636 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14637 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14638 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14639
14640ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14641 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14642 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14643
14644ssl_bc_cipher : string
14645 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14646 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14647
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014648ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14649 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14650 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14651 session or a TLS ticket.
14652
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014653ssl_bc_protocol : string
14654 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14655 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14656
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014657ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014658 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014659 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14660 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014661
14662ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14663 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14664 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14665 if session was reused or not.
14666
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014667ssl_bc_session_key : binary
14668 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
14669 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14670 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14671 BoringSSL.
14672
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014673ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14674 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14675 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014677ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14678 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14679 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14680 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14681 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14682 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014684ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14685 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14686 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14687 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14688 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014689
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014690ssl_c_der : binary
14691 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14692 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14693 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014695ssl_c_err : integer
14696 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14697 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14698 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14699 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14700 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014702ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14703 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14704 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14705 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14706 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14707 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14708 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14709 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14710 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712ssl_c_key_alg : string
14713 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14714 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14715 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717ssl_c_notafter : string
14718 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14719 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14720 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722ssl_c_notbefore : string
14723 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14724 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14725 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014727ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14728 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14729 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14730 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14731 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14732 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14733 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14734 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14735 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014737ssl_c_serial : binary
14738 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14739 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14740 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014742ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14743 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14744 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14745 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014746 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14747 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14748
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014749 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014750 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014752ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14753 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14754 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14755 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757ssl_c_used : boolean
14758 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14759 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761ssl_c_verify : integer
14762 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14763 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14764 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14765 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767ssl_c_version : integer
14768 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14769 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014770
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014771ssl_f_der : binary
14772 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14773 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14774 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014776ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14777 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14778 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14779 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14780 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014781 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14783 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14784 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786ssl_f_key_alg : string
14787 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14788 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14789 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791ssl_f_notafter : string
14792 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14793 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14794 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014796ssl_f_notbefore : string
14797 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14798 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14799 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14802 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14803 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14804 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14805 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14806 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14807 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14808 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14809 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811ssl_f_serial : binary
14812 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14813 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14814 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014815
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014816ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14817 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14818 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14819 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14822 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14823 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14824 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826ssl_f_version : integer
14827 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14828 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14829
14830ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014831 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14832 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14833 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014835 Example :
14836 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14837 listen http-https
14838 bind :80
14839 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14840 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14841
14842ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14843 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14844 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14845
14846ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014847 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14849 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14850 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14851 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14852 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14853 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14854 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14855 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857ssl_fc_cipher : string
14858 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14859 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014860
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014861ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14862 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14863 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014864 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014865
14866ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14867 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14868 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014869 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014870
14871ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14872 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14873 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14874 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014875 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014876 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014877
14878ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14879 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14880 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014881 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014884 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14885 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014886 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14887 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14888 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14889 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014890
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014891ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14892 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14893 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14894 wait until the handshake happened.
14895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14897 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014898 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14899 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14900 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14901 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014902
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014903ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014904 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010014905 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
14906 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014909 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14911 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14912 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14913 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14914 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14915 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14916 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918ssl_fc_protocol : string
14919 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14920 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014921
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014922ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014923 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014924 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14925 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14928 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14929 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14930 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14931 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014932
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014933ssl_fc_session_key : binary
14934 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
14935 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14936 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14937 BoringSSL.
14938
14939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940ssl_fc_sni : string
14941 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14942 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14943 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14944 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14945 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14946
14947 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14948 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14949 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014950 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14951 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14955 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14958 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14959 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014960
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149627.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014963------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14966sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14967only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14968For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14969be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14970can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14971sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14972for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14973content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014976 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14978 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14981 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014982 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014983 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014984
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014985req.hdrs : string
14986 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14987 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14988 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14989 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14990
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014991req.hdrs_bin : binary
14992 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14993 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14994 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14995 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14996 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14997 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14998
14999 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15000
15001 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15002 str: <int:length><bytes>
15003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004req.len : integer
15005req_len : integer (deprecated)
15006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15007 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15008 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15009 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15010 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15011 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15012 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15013 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15016 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015017 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15018 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15019 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15020 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022 ACL alternatives :
15023 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15026 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15027 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15028 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15029 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031 ACL alternatives :
15032 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015036req.proto_http : boolean
15037req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15038 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15039 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15040 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15041 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15042 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15043 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15044 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046 Example:
15047 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15048 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15049 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015050 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15053rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15054 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15055 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15056 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15057 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15058 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15059 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15060 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15063 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15064 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15065 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15066 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15067 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069 ACL derivatives :
15070 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072 Example :
15073 listen tse-farm
15074 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15075 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15076 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15077 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15078 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15079 persist rdp-cookie
15080 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15081 # This is only useful makes sense if
15082 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15083 stick-table type string size 204800
15084 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15085 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15086 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15089 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15092rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15093 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15094 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15095 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15096 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098 ACL derivatives :
15099 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015100
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015101req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15102 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15103 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015104 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15105 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15106 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15107 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15108 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15111req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15112 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15113 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15114 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15115 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15116 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15117 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15118 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120req.ssl_sni : string
15121req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15122 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15123 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15124 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15125 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15126 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15127 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15128 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15129 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15130 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15131 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15132 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15133 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135 ACL derivatives :
15136 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138 Examples :
15139 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15140 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15141 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15142 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15143 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015144
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015145req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15146 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15147 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15148 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15149 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15150 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15151 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15152 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15153 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15154 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156req.ssl_ver : integer
15157req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15158 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15159 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15160 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15161 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15162 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15163 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15164 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015165 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168 ACL derivatives :
15169 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015170
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015171res.len : integer
15172 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15173 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15174 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15175 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15176 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15177 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15178 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15179 content inspection.
15180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15182 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015183 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15184 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15185 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15186 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015188res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15189 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15190 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15191 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15192 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015194 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015195
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015196res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15197rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15198 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15199 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15200 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15201 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15202 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15203 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15204 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206wait_end : boolean
15207 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15208 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015209 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15211 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015212 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15214 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216 Examples :
15217 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15218 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15219 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15222 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15223 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15224 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15225 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15226 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15227 tcp-request content reject
15228
15229
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152307.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231--------------------------------------
15232
15233It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15234This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15235data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15236its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15237HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15238content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15239to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15240more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15241response are indexed.
15242
15243base : string
15244 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15245 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15246 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15247 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15248 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15249 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15250 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15251 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15252
15253 ACL derivatives :
15254 base : exact string match
15255 base_beg : prefix match
15256 base_dir : subdir match
15257 base_dom : domain match
15258 base_end : suffix match
15259 base_len : length match
15260 base_reg : regex match
15261 base_sub : substring match
15262
15263base32 : integer
15264 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15265 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15266 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015267 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15268 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15269 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270
15271base32+src : binary
15272 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15273 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15274 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15275 per-URL counters.
15276
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015277capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15278 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15279 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15280 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15281
15282capture.req.method : string
15283 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15284 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15285 because it's allocated.
15286
15287capture.req.uri : string
15288 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15289 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15290 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15291 allocated.
15292
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015293capture.req.ver : string
15294 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15295 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15296 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15297
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015298capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15299 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15300 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15301 The first entry is an index of 0.
15302 See also: "capture response header"
15303
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015304capture.res.ver : string
15305 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15306 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15307 persistent flag.
15308
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015309req.body : binary
15310 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15311 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15312 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15313 the first chunk is analyzed.
15314
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015315req.body_param([<name>) : string
15316 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15317 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15318 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15319 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15320 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15321 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15322 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15323 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15324 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15325 given.
15326
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015327req.body_len : integer
15328 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15329 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15330 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15331 "option http-buffer-request".
15332
15333req.body_size : integer
15334 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15335 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15336 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15337 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15338 "option http-buffer-request".
15339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340req.cook([<name>]) : string
15341cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15342 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15343 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15344 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15345 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15346 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15347 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15348 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15349 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15350
15351 ACL derivatives :
15352 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15353 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15354 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15355 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15356 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15357 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15358 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15359 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015361req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15362cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15363 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15364 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15367cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15368 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15369 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15370 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15371 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015373cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15374 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15375 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15376 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15377 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015378 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015379 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15380 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15381 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15382 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15385 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15386 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15387 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15388 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015389 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15392 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15393 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15394 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15395 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15396 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15397 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15398 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15399 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15402 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15403 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15404 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15405 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015407req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15409 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15410 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15411 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15412 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15413 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15414 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15415 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015416 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015418 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420 ACL derivatives :
15421 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15422 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15423 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15424 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15425 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15426 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15427 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15428 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15429
15430req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15431hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15432 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15433 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15434 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15435 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15436 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15437 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15438 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15439 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15440 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15441
15442req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15443hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15444 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15445 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15446 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15447 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15448 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015449 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15451 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15452
15453req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15454hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15455 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15456 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15457 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15458 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15459 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15460 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15461 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15462
15463http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15464 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15465 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15466 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15467 basic auth is supported.
15468
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015469http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15470 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15471 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15472 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15473 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15475 basic auth is supported.
15476
15477 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015478 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15479 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15480 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15481 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482
15483http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015484 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15485 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15487 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489method : integer + string
15490 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15491 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15492 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15493 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15494 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15495 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15496 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498 ACL derivatives :
15499 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501 Example :
15502 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15503 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15504 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506path : string
15507 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15508 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15509 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15510 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15511 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015512 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515 ACL derivatives :
15516 path : exact string match
15517 path_beg : prefix match
15518 path_dir : subdir match
15519 path_dom : domain match
15520 path_end : suffix match
15521 path_len : length match
15522 path_reg : regex match
15523 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015524
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015525query : string
15526 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15527 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15528 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15529 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015530 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015531 which stops before the question mark.
15532
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015533req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15534 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15535 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15536 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15537 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539req.ver : string
15540req_ver : string (deprecated)
15541 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15542 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15543 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545 ACL derivatives :
15546 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548res.comp : boolean
15549 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15550 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15551 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553res.comp_algo : string
15554 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15555 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15556 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558res.cook([<name>]) : string
15559scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15560 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15561 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15562 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 ACL derivatives :
15565 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15568scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15569 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15570 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15571 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15574scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15575 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15576 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15577 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15580 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15581 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15582 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15583 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15584 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15585 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15586 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15587 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15588 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15591 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15592 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15593 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15594 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15595 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15598shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15600 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15601 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15602 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15603 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15604 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15605 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15606 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608 ACL derivatives :
15609 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15610 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15611 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15612 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15613 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15614 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15615 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15616 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15617
15618res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15619shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15620 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15621 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15622 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15623 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15624 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15627shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15628 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15629 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15630 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15631 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15632 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15633 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015634
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015635res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15636 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15637 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15638 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15639 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15642shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15643 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15644 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15645 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15646 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15647 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15648 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650res.ver : string
15651resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15652 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15653 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655 ACL derivatives :
15656 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15659 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15660 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015661 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15665 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667status : integer
15668 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15669 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15670 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015671
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015672unique-id : string
15673 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15674 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15675 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15676 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15677 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15678 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680url : string
15681 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15682 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15683 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15684 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15685 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15686 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15687 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 ACL derivatives :
15690 url : exact string match
15691 url_beg : prefix match
15692 url_dir : subdir match
15693 url_dom : domain match
15694 url_end : suffix match
15695 url_len : length match
15696 url_reg : regex match
15697 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699url_ip : ip
15700 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15701 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15702 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15703 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15704 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15705 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15706 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708url_port : integer
15709 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15710 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15711 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15712 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015713
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015714urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15715url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15717 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015718 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15719 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15720 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15721 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15723 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015724 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15725 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727 ACL derivatives :
15728 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15729 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15730 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15731 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15732 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15733 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15734 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15735 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015736
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 Example :
15739 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15740 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15741 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15742 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015743
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015744urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15746 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15747 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015748
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015749url32 : integer
15750 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15751 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15752 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15753 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15754 is an unsigned integer.
15755
15756url32+src : binary
15757 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15758 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15759 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15760
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157627.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015763---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015765Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15766every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015767order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015769ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15770---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015771FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015772HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015773HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15774HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015775HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15776HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15777HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15778HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15779LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015780METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015781METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015782METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15783METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15784METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15785METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015786METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015787METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015788RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015789REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015790TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015791WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15792---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015793
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157958. Logging
15796----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015797
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015798One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15799provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15800very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15801provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15802state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015803to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015804headers.
15805
15806In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15807about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15808send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15809
15810 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15811 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15812 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15813 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15814 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015815 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015816 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015817
15818The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15819allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15820as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15821while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15822real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15823delay.
15824
15825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158268.1. Log levels
15827---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015828
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015829TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015830source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015831HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15832in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15833track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15834syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15835about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015836
15837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158388.2. Log formats
15839----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015840
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015841HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015842and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15843slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15844options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015845
15846 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15847 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15848 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15849 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15850 extents.
15851
15852 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15853 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15854 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15855 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15856 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15857
15858 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15859 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15860 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15861 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15862 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15863
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015864 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15865 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15866 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15867 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15868
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015869 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15870
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015871Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15872specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15873field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15874servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15875always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15876identifier.
15877
15878Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15879 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15880 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15881 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15882 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15883
15884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158858.2.1. Default log format
15886-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015887
15888This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15889as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15890format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15891
15892 Example :
15893 listen www
15894 mode http
15895 log global
15896 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15897
15898 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15899 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15900 (www/HTTP)
15901
15902 Field Format Extract from the example above
15903 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15904 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15905 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15906 4 'to' to
15907 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15908 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15909
15910Detailed fields description :
15911 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15912 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15913 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15914 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15915 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15916 and processed the connection.
15917 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15918
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015919In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15920"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15921connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015923It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15924will eventually disappear.
15925
15926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159278.2.2. TCP log format
15928---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015929
15930The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15931is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15932information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15933counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15934emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15935environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15936the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15937sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015938specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15939not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15940fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15941marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015942
15943 Example :
15944 frontend fnt
15945 mode tcp
15946 option tcplog
15947 log global
15948 default_backend bck
15949
15950 backend bck
15951 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15952
15953 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15954 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15955 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15956
15957 Field Format Extract from the example above
15958 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15959 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15960 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15961 4 frontend_name fnt
15962 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15963 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15964 7 bytes_read* 212
15965 8 termination_state --
15966 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15967 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15968
15969Detailed fields description :
15970 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015971 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15972 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15973 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015974 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015975 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015976 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015977
15978 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015979 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15980 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15981 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015982
15983 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15984 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15985 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020015986 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
15987 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
15988 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
15989 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015990
15991 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15992 and processed the connection.
15993
15994 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15995 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15996 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15997 applications.
15998
15999 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16000 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16001 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16002 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16003 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16004
16005 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16006 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16007 See "Timers" below for more details.
16008
16009 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16010 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16011 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16012 "Timers" below for more details.
16013
16014 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016015 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016016 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16017 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16018 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16019 details.
16020
16021 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16022 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16023 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16024 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16025 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16026
16027 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16028 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16029 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16030 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16031 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16032 for more details.
16033
16034 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016035 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016036 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16037 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16038 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016039 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016040
16041 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16042 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16043 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16044 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16045 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16046 caused by a denial of service attack.
16047
16048 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16049 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16050 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16051 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16052 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16053 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16054 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16055 denial of service attack.
16056
16057 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16058 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16059 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16060 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16061 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16062 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16063 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16064 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16065 be processed than on other servers.
16066
16067 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16068 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16069 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16070 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16071 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16072 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16073 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16074 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16075 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16076 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16077 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16078 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16079 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16080
16081 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16082 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16083 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16084 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16085 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16086 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016087 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016088 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16089
16090 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16091 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16092 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16093 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16094 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16095 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016096 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16098 occurs.
16099
16100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161018.2.3. HTTP log format
16102----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016103
16104The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16105is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16106the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16107are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16108emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16109generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16110"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16111which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016112frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16113is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016114
16115Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16116slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16117with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16118
16119 Example :
16120 frontend http-in
16121 mode http
16122 option httplog
16123 log global
16124 default_backend bck
16125
16126 backend static
16127 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16128
16129 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16130 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16131 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016132 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016133
16134 Field Format Extract from the example above
16135 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16136 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016137 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016138 4 frontend_name http-in
16139 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016140 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016141 7 status_code 200
16142 8 bytes_read* 2750
16143 9 captured_request_cookie -
16144 10 captured_response_cookie -
16145 11 termination_state ----
16146 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16147 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16148 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16149 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16150 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016152Detailed fields description :
16153 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016154 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16155 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16156 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016157 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016158 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016159 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016160
16161 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016162 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16163 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16164 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016165
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016166 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16167 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168
16169 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16170 and processed the connection.
16171
16172 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16173 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16174 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16175
16176 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16177 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16178 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16179 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16180 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16181 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16182
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016183 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16184 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16185 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16186 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16187 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16188 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016189 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16190 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016191
16192 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16193 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016194 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016195
16196 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16197 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016198 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16199 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016200
16201 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16202 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16203 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16204 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16205 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016206 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16207 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016208
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016209 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16210 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16211 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16212 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16213 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16214 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16215 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016216 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016217
16218 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16219 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16220 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16221
16222 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16223 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16224 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16225 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16226 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16227 overflowing.
16228
16229 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16230 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16231 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16232 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16233 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16234 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16235 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16236 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16237
16238 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16239 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16240 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16241 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16242 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16243 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16244 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16245 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16246
16247 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16248 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16249 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16250 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16251 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16252 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16253 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16254
16255 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016256 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016257 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16258 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16259 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016260 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016261 system.
16262
16263 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16264 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16265 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16266 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16267 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16268 caused by a denial of service attack.
16269
16270 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16271 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16272 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16273 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16274 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16275 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16276 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16277 denial of service attack.
16278
16279 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16280 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16281 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16282 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16283 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16284 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16285 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16286 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16287 processed than on other servers.
16288
16289 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16290 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16291 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16292 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16293 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16294 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16295 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16296 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16297 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16298 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16299 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16300 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16301 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16302
16303 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16304 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16305 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16306 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16307 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16308 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016309 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016310 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16311
16312 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16313 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16314 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16315 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16316 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16317 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016318 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016319 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16320 occurs.
16321
16322 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16323 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16324 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16325 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16326 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16327 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16328 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16329 cookies" below for more details.
16330
16331 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16332 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16333 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16334 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16335 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16336 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16337 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16338 and cookies" below for more details.
16339
16340 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16341 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16342 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16343 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16344 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16345 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16346 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16347 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16348
16349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200163508.2.4. Custom log format
16351------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016352
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016353The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016354mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016355
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016356HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016357Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16358separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16359prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16360
16361Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16362variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016363("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016364
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016365If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016366as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016367less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16368the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16369
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016370Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016371In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016372in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016373
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016374Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16375'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16376https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16377such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16378
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016379Flags are :
16380 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016381 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016382 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16383 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016384
16385 Example:
16386
16387 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16388 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16389
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016390 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16391
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016392At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16393
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016394 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16395 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016396
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016397the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016398
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016399 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16400 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16401 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016402
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016403and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16404
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016405 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16406 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016407
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016408Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16409
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016410 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016411 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016412 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16413 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16414 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016415 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16416 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16417 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016418 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016419 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16420 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016421 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016422 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16423 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016424 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016425 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016426 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016427 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016428 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016429 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016430 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016431 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16432 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16433 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16434 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16435 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016436 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016437 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16438 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016439 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016440 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16441 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016442 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16443 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16444 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016445 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016446 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16447 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016448 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016449 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16450 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16451 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016452 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016453 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016454 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16455 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16456 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16457 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016458 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016459 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016460 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016461 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016462 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016463 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016464 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16465 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16466 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016467 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016468 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16469 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016470 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016471 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16472 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016473 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016474 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016475 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016476 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016477
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016478 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016479
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016480
164818.2.5. Error log format
16482-----------------------
16483
16484When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16485protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16486By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16487"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016488will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016489logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16490
16491The format looks like this :
16492
16493 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16494 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16495 Connection error during SSL handshake
16496
16497 Field Format Extract from the example above
16498 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16499 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16500 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16501 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16502 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16503
16504These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16505failures.
16506
16507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165088.3. Advanced logging options
16509-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016510
16511Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16512just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16513options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16514for more information about their usage.
16515
16516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165178.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16518------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016519
16520It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16521haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16522commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16523monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16524ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16525
16526 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16527 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16528 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16529 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16530
16531 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16532 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16533 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016534 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016535 such as other load-balancers.
16536
16537 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16538 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16539 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16540
16541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165428.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16543----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016544
16545The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16546what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16547or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016548"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016549just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16550log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16551after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16552is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16553with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16554with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16555
16556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165578.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16558------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016559
16560Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16561for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16562"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16563retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16564raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16565a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16566file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16567you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16568"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16569
16570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165718.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16572--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016573
16574Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16575multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16576them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16577"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16578logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16579error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16580and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16581too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16582useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16583alternative.
16584
16585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165868.4. Timing events
16587------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016588
16589Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16590reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16591the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16592frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016593mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16594addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16595
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016596Timings events in HTTP mode:
16597
16598 first request 2nd request
16599 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16600 t tr t tr ...
16601 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16602 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16603 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16604 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16605 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16606
16607Timings events in TCP mode:
16608
16609 TCP session
16610 |<----------------->|
16611 t t
16612 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16613 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16614 |<------ Tt ------->|
16615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016616 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016617 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016618 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16619 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16620 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016621 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016622 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16623 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16624 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16625 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016626
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016627 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16628 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16629 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016630 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16631 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16632 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16633 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16634 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16635 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016636
16637 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16638 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16639 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16640 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16641 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16642 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16643 request typed by hand during a test.
16644
16645 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16646 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016647 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016648 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16649 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16650 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16651 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016652
16653 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16654 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16655 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16656 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16657 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16658
16659 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16660 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16661 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16662 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16663 connection never established.
16664
16665 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16666 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16667 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16668 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16669 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16670 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16671 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16672 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16673 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16674 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16675 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16676
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016677 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16678 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16679 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16680 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16681 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16682 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16683
16684 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16685
16686 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16687 "Ta" can never be negative.
16688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16690 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016691 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16692 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016693 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016695 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016696
16697 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016698 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16699 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016700
16701These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16702protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16703that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016704due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16705"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16706that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016707
16708Most common cases :
16709
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016710 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16711 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16712 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16713 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16714 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16715 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16716 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16717 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16718 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16719 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16720 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016721 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016722
16723 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16724 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16725 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16726 of ms on remote networks.
16727
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016728 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16729 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16730 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016731
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016732 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16733 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16734 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16735 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16736 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16737 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16738 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16739 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16740 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016741
16742Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16743
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016744 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016745 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016746 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016747
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016748 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016749 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16750 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16751
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016752 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016753 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16754 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16755 flags.
16756
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016757 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16758 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016759 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16760 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16761 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16762 the client connection was maintained open.
16763
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016764 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016765 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016766 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016767 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16768
16769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167708.5. Session state at disconnection
16771-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016772
16773TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16774"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
167752-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16776each of which has a special meaning :
16777
16778 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16779 session to terminate :
16780
16781 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16782
16783 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16784 server explicitly refused it.
16785
16786 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16787 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16788 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16789 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016790 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016791
16792 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16793 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016794
16795 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16796 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16797 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16798 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16799 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16800
16801 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16802 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16803 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16804 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16805 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16806
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016807 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16808 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16809
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016810 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16811 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16812 backup connections when going up.
16813
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016814 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016816 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16817 send or receive data.
16818
16819 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16820 send or receive data.
16821
16822 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16823 with nothing left in the buffers.
16824
16825 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16826
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016827 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016828 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16829
16830 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16831 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16832 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16833 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16834 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16835
16836 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16837 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16838
16839 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16840 server (HTTP only).
16841
16842 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16843
16844 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16845 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16846 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16847
16848 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16849 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16850 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16851
16852 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16853
16854 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16855 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16856
16857 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16858 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16859 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16860
16861 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16862 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016863 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16864 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016865
16866 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16867 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16868 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16869 another server.
16870
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016871 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016872 server.
16873
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016874 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16875 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16876 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16877 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16878
16879 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16880 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16881 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16882 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16883
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016884 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16885 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16886 "use-server" rule).
16887
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016888 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16889
16890 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16891 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16892
16893 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16894
16895 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16896 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16897 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16898
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016899 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16900 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016901 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016902 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16903 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16904
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016905 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16906
16907 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16908 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16909
16910 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16911
16912 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16913
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016914The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16915was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016916helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16917starvation, attacks, etc...
16918
16919The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16920alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16921easier finding and understanding.
16922
16923 Flags Reason
16924
16925 -- Normal termination.
16926
16927 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16928 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16929 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16930 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16931
16932 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16933 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16934 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16935 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16936 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16937 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016938
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016939 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16940 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016941 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016942
16943 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16944 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16945 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16946
16947 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16948 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16949 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16950 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16951 the server takes too long to respond.
16952
16953 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16954 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16955 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16956 long a time to respond.
16957
16958 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16959 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16960 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16961 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016962 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16963 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016964
16965 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16966 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16967 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16968 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16969 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016970 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016971 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16972 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16973 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16974 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16975 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16976 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16977 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16978 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016979 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016980 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16981 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16982 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016983
16984 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16985 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016986 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16987 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16988 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16989 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016990
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016991 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16992 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016994 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016995 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16996 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016997 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016998 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16999 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17000
17001 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17002 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17003 503 or 504 here.
17004
17005 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17006 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17007 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17008 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17009 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17010
17011 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17012 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017013 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017014 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17015 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17016
17017 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17018 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17019 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17020 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17021 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17022 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17023 between haproxy and the server.
17024
17025 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17026 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17027 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17028 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17029 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17030 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17031 solution is to fix the application.
17032
17033 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17034 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17035 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17036 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17037 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17038 external attacks.
17039
17040 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17041 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017042 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017043 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17044 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17045
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017046 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17047 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17048 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017049 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017050 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017051
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017052 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17053 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17054 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17055 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017056 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17057 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17058 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17059 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17060 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017061
17062 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17063 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17064 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17065 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17066
17067 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17068 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17069 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17070 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17071
17072 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17073 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17074 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17075 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17076
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017077The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17078persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17079important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17080re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17081
17082 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17083
17084 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17085 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17086 set on a GET request.
17087
17088 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17089 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017090 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017091 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17092
17093 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17094 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17095 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17096
17097 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17098 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17099 already got a cookie.
17100
17101 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17102 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17103 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17104 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17105 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17106
17107 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17108 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17109 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17110
17111 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17112 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17113 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17114
17115 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17116 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17117
17118 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17119 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17120 then advertised in the response.
17121
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171238.6. Non-printable characters
17124-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017125
17126In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17127consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17128converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17129prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17130being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17131escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17132is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17133'}' when logging headers.
17134
17135Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17136issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17137containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17138
17139Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17140the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17141performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17142
17143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171448.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17145---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017146
17147Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17148achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017149section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017150cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17151the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17152the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017153locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017154not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17155user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17156a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17157wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17158
17159 Examples :
17160 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17161 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17162
17163 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17164 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17165
17166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171678.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17168---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017169
17170Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17171proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17172the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17173server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17174
17175Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17176response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017177section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017178
17179It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017180time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17181appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017182are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17183and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17184follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17185request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17186in the logs.
17187
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017188As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17189frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17190an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17191
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017192 Example :
17193 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17194 listen proxy-out
17195 mode http
17196 option httplog
17197 option logasap
17198 log global
17199 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17200
17201 # log the name of the virtual server
17202 capture request header Host len 20
17203
17204 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17205 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17206
17207 # log the beginning of the referrer
17208 capture request header Referer len 20
17209
17210 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17211 capture response header Server len 20
17212
17213 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17214 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17215
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017216 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017217 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17218
17219 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17220 capture response header Via len 20
17221
17222 # log the URL location during a redirection
17223 capture response header Location len 20
17224
17225 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17226 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17227 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17228 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17229 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17230
17231 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17232 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17233 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17234 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017235 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017236
17237 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17238 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17239 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17240 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17241 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017242 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017243
17244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172458.9. Examples of logs
17246---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017247
17248These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17249them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17250reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17251
17252 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17253 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17254 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17255
17256 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17257 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17258
17259 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17260 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17261 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17262
17263 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17264 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17265
17266 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17267 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17268 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17269
17270 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017271 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017272 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17273 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17274
17275 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17276 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17277 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17278
17279 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17280 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017281 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017282 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17283 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17284 to return the 502 and not the server.
17285
17286 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017287 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017288
17289 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17290 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17291 Nothing was sent to any server.
17292
17293 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17294 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17295
17296 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17297 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017298 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017299 send a 408 return code to the client.
17300
17301 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17302 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17303
17304 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17305 5 seconds ("c----").
17306
17307 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17308 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017309 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017310
17311 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017312 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017313 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17314 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17315 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17316 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17317 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017318
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017319
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200173209. Supported filters
17321--------------------
17322
17323Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17324accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17325unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17326
17327See also : "filter"
17328
173299.1. Trace
17330----------
17331
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017332filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017333
17334 Arguments:
17335 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17336 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17337
17338 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17339 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17340 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17341 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017343 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017344 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17345 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17346 amount of the parsed data.
17347
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017348 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017349
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017350This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17351callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17352information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17353filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17354
17355Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17356tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17357a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17358
17359
173609.2. HTTP compression
17361---------------------
17362
17363filter compression
17364
17365The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17366keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17367when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17368use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17369used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17370filters evaluation order.
17371
17372See also : "compression"
17373
17374
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200173759.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17376--------------------------------------------
17377
17378filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17379
17380 Arguments :
17381
17382 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17383 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17384 parsed.
17385
17386 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17387 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17388 part must be placed in its own scope.
17389
17390The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17391external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017392streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017393exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17394also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17395
17396SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17397the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17398
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017399For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017400"doc/SPOE.txt".
17401
17402Important note:
17403 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17404 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17405
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001740610. Cache
17407---------
17408
17409HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17410(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17411RAM.
17412
17413The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017414this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017415
17416If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17417independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17418when we try to allocate a new one.
17419
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017420The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017421
17422It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17423"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17424for more details.
17425
17426When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17427replaced by "<CACHE>".
17428
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001742910.1. Limitation
17430----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017431
17432The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17433
17434- If the response is not a 200
17435- If the response contains a Vary header
17436- If the response does not contain a Content-Length header or if the
17437 Content-Length + the headers size is greater than a buffer size - the
17438 reserve.
17439- If the response is not cacheable
17440
17441- If the request is not a GET
17442- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017443- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017444
17445Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17446to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017447if they modify the response (compression for example).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017448
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001744910.2. Setup
17450-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017451
17452To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17453the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17454
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001745510.2.1. Cache section
17456---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017457
17458cache <name>
17459 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17460 size of cache is mandatory.
17461
17462total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017463 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17464 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017465
17466max-age <seconds>
17467 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17468 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17469 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17470 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17471 default.
17472
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001747310.2.2. Proxy section
17474---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017475
17476http-request cache-use <name>
17477 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17478 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17479 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17480 after this one.
17481
17482http-response cache-store <name>
17483 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17484 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17485 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17486 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17487
17488
17489Example:
17490
17491 backend bck1
17492 mode http
17493
17494 http-request cache-use foobar
17495 http-response cache-store foobar
17496 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17497
17498 cache foobar
17499 total-max-size 4
17500 max-age 240
17501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017502/*
17503 * Local variables:
17504 * fill-column: 79
17505 * End:
17506 */